blob: 78f0f134eb2a5bdd4898c768735a3f516726e06e [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau0e658fb2016-11-25 16:55:50 +01005 version 1.8
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreaue59fcdd2016-11-25 16:39:17 +01007 2016/11/25
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020054
554. Proxies
564.1. Proxy keywords matrix
574.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
58
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200595. Bind and Server options
605.1. Bind options
615.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200625.3. Server DNS resolution
635.3.1. Global overview
645.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020065
666. HTTP header manipulation
67
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200687. Using ACLs and fetching samples
697.1. ACL basics
707.1.1. Matching booleans
717.1.2. Matching integers
727.1.3. Matching strings
737.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
747.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
757.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
767.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
777.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200787.3.1. Converters
797.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
807.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
817.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
827.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
837.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200847.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020085
868. Logging
878.1. Log levels
888.2. Log formats
898.2.1. Default log format
908.2.2. TCP log format
918.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100928.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100938.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200948.3. Advanced logging options
958.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
968.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
978.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
988.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
998.4. Timing events
1008.5. Session state at disconnection
1018.6. Non-printable characters
1028.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1038.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1048.9. Examples of logs
105
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001069. Supported filters
1079.1. Trace
1089.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001099.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200110
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200111
1121. Quick reminder about HTTP
113----------------------------
114
115When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
116fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
117on almost anything found in the contents.
118
119However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
120formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
121correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
122
123
1241.1. The HTTP transaction model
125-------------------------------
126
127The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100128to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200129from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
130connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
131will involve a new connection :
132
133 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
134
135In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
136establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
137by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
138length.
139
140Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
141to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
142however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
143response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
144header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
145
146 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
147
148Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
149power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
150but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200151a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200152
153A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
154keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
155second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
156page :
157
158 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
159
160This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
161latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
162correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
163the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100164server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200165
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100166By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
167connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
168leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
169start of a new request.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200170
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100171HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
172 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
173 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
174 everything else is forwarded with no analysis.
175 - passive close : tunnel with "Connection: close" added in both directions.
176 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
177 - forced close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
178
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200179
1801.2. HTTP request
181-----------------
182
183First, let's consider this HTTP request :
184
185 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100186 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200187 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
188 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
189 3 User-agent: my small browser
190 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
191 5 Accept: image/png
192
193
1941.2.1. The Request line
195-----------------------
196
197Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
198
199 - a METHOD : GET
200 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
201 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
202
203All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
204which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
205followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
206is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
207desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
208the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
209
210The URI itself can have several forms :
211
212 - A "relative URI" :
213
214 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
215
216 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
217 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
218
219 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
220
221 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
222
223 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
224 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
225 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
226 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
227 must accept this form too.
228
229 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
230 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
231 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100232
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200233 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
234 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
235 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
236 other protocols too.
237
238In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
239mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
240on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
241It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
242specific to the language, framework or application in use.
243
244
2451.2.2. The request headers
246--------------------------
247
248The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
249beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
250an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
251Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
252values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
253encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
254the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
255define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
256
257Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
258their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
259"Connection:" header).
260
261The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
262that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
263is one valid form of empty line.
264
265Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
266headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
267about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
268application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
269
270Important note:
271 As suggested by RFC2616, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
272 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
273 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
274 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
275
276
2771.3. HTTP response
278------------------
279
280An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
281messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
282
283 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100284 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200285 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
286 2 Content-length: 350
287 3 Content-Type: text/html
288
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200289As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
290codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
291response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100292continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
293the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
294following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
295sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
296(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
297correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
298such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
299state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
300over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
301if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
302information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200303
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200304
3051.3.1. The Response line
306------------------------
307
308Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
309
310 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
311 - a status code : 200
312 - a reason : OK
313
314The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200315 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200316 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
317 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
318 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
319 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
320
321Please refer to RFC2616 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100322"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200323found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
324messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
325or "Authentication Required".
326
327Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
328
329 Code When / reason
330 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
331 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
332 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
333 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100334 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
335 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200336 400 for an invalid or too large request
337 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
338 accessing the stats page)
339 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
340 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
341 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
342 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
343 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
344 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
345 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
346 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
347 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
348
349The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3504.2).
351
352
3531.3.2. The response headers
354---------------------------
355
356Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
357the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
358details.
359
360
3612. Configuring HAProxy
362----------------------
363
3642.1. Configuration file format
365------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200366
367HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
368
369 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
370 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
371 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
372 "frontend" and "backend".
373
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100374The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
375referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200376delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100377
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200378
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02003792.2. Quoting and escaping
380-------------------------
381
382HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
383many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
384with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
385single quotes.
386
387If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
388them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
389escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
390
391Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
392
393 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
394 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
395 \\ to use a backslash
396 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
397 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
398
399Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
400the interpretation of:
401
402 space as a parameter separator
403 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
404 # hash as a comment start
405
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200406Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
407-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
408backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
409
410Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200411quoting.
412
413Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
414nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
415
416Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
417equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
418
419 Example:
420 # those are equivalents:
421 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
422 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
423 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
424 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
425 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
426
427 # those are equivalents:
428 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
429 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
430 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
431 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
432
433
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004342.3. Environment variables
435--------------------------
436
437HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
438interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
439configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
440optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
441shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
442underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
443
444 Example:
445
446 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
447
448 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
449
450 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
451
452
4532.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200454----------------
455
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100456Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100457values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
458otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
459numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
460for every keyword. Supported units are :
461
462 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
463 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
464 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
465 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
466 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
467 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
468
469
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02004702.4. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200471-------------
472
473 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
474 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
475 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
476 global
477 daemon
478 maxconn 256
479
480 defaults
481 mode http
482 timeout connect 5000ms
483 timeout client 50000ms
484 timeout server 50000ms
485
486 frontend http-in
487 bind *:80
488 default_backend servers
489
490 backend servers
491 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
492
493
494 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
495 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
496 global
497 daemon
498 maxconn 256
499
500 defaults
501 mode http
502 timeout connect 5000ms
503 timeout client 50000ms
504 timeout server 50000ms
505
506 listen http-in
507 bind *:80
508 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
509
510
511Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
512
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100513 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200514
515
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005163. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200517--------------------
518
519Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
520are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
521of them have command-line equivalents.
522
523The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
524
525 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200526 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200527 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200528 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200529 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200530 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200531 - description
532 - deviceatlas-json-file
533 - deviceatlas-log-level
534 - deviceatlas-separator
535 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900536 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200537 - gid
538 - group
539 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200540 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100541 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200542 - lua-load
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200543 - nbproc
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200544 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200545 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100546 - presetenv
547 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200548 - uid
549 - ulimit-n
550 - user
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100551 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200552 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200553 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
554 - ssl-default-bind-options
555 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
556 - ssl-default-server-options
557 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100558 - ssl-server-verify
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100559 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100560 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100561 - 51degrees-data-file
562 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200563 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200564 - 51degrees-cache-size
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +0100565 - wurfl-data-file
566 - wurfl-information-list
567 - wurfl-information-list-separator
568 - wurfl-engine-mode
569 - wurfl-cache-size
570 - wurfl-useragent-priority
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100571
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200572 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200573 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200574 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200575 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100576 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100577 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100578 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200579 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200580 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200581 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200582 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200583 - noepoll
584 - nokqueue
585 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100586 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300587 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000588 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200589 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200590 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200591 - server-state-file
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200592 - tune.buffers.limit
593 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200594 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200595 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100596 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100597 - tune.http.cookielen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200598 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100599 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100600 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100601 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100602 - tune.lua.session-timeout
603 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200604 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100605 - tune.maxaccept
606 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200607 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200608 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200609 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100610 - tune.rcvbuf.client
611 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100612 - tune.recv_enough
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100613 - tune.sndbuf.client
614 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100615 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100616 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200617 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100618 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200619 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200620 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100621 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200622 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100623 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200624 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
625 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
626 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100627 - tune.zlib.memlevel
628 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100629
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200630 * Debugging
631 - debug
632 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200633
634
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006353.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200636------------------------------------
637
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200638ca-base <dir>
639 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200640 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
641 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200642
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200643chroot <jail dir>
644 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
645 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
646 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
647 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
648 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
649 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100650
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100651cpu-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num> <cpu-set>...
652 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process to a specific CPU
653 set. This means that the process will never run on other CPUs. The "cpu-map"
654 directive specifies CPU sets for process sets. The first argument is the
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100655 process number to bind. This process must have a number between 1 and 32 or
656 64, depending on the machine's word size, and any process IDs above nbproc
657 are ignored. It is possible to specify all processes at once using "all",
658 only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like with the
659 "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are CPU sets.
660 Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a range with
661 two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers or ranges
662 may be specified, and the processes will be allowed to bind to all of them.
663 Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map"
664 directive will replace the previous ones when they overlap.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100665
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200666crt-base <dir>
667 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
668 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
669 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
670
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200671daemon
672 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
673 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
674 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
675
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200676deviceatlas-json-file <path>
677 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
678 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by Haproxy process.
679
680deviceatlas-log-level <value>
681 Sets the level of informations returned by the API. This directive is
682 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
683
684deviceatlas-separator <char>
685 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
686 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
687
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100688deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200689 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
690 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
691 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100692
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900693external-check
694 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
695 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
696 See "option external-check".
697
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200698gid <number>
699 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
700 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
701 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100702 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
703 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200704 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100705
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200706group <group name>
707 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
708 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100709
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200710log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200711 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
712 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100713 configured with "log global".
714
715 <address> can be one of:
716
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100717 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100718 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
719 port).
720
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100721 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
722 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
723 port).
724
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100725 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
726 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
727 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
728 writeable).
729
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200730 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
731 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100732
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200733 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
734 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
735 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
736 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
737 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
738 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
739 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
740 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
741 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
742 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
743 JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
744
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200745 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
746 one of the following :
747
748 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
749 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
750
751 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
752 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
753
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100754 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200755
756 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
757 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
758 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
759
760 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200761 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
762 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
763 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
764 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
765 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
766 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200767
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200768 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200769
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100770log-send-hostname [<string>]
771 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
772 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
773 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
774 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
775 the logs.
776
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000777log-tag <string>
778 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
779 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
780 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +0100781 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000782
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100783lua-load <file>
784 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
785 used multiple times.
786
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200787nbproc <number>
788 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
789 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
790 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
791 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
792 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
793
794pidfile <pidfile>
795 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
796 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
797 starting the process. See also "daemon".
798
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100799presetenv <name> <value>
800 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
801 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
802 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
803 and "unsetenv".
804
805resetenv [<name> ...]
806 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
807 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
808 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
809 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
810 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
811 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
812 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
813 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
814
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100815stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200816 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
817 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
818 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
819 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
820 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
821 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100822 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +0200823 word size (32 or 64). A better option consists in using the "process" setting
824 of the "stats socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200825
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200826server-state-base <directory>
827 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +0200828 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
829 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200830
831server-state-file <file>
832 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
833 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
834 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
835 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
836 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
837 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
838 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
839 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +0200840 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
841 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200842
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100843setenv <name> <value>
844 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
845 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
846 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
847 and "unsetenv".
848
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100849ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
850 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
851 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300852 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake for all "bind" lines which
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100853 do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
854 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string such
855 as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes). Please check the
856 "bind" keyword for more information.
857
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100858ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
859 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
860 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
861 keyword to see available options.
862
863 Example:
864 global
865 ssl-default-bind-options no-sslv3 no-tls-tickets
866
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100867ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
868 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
869 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300870 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server, for all "server"
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100871 lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is
872 defined in "man 1 ciphers". Please check the "server" keyword for more
873 information.
874
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100875ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
876 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
877 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
878 keyword to see available options.
879
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +0200880ssl-dh-param-file <file>
881 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
882 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
883 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
884 which do not explicitely define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
885 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200886 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
887 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
888 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
889 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +0200890 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
891 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
892 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
893
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100894ssl-server-verify [none|required]
895 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
896 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
897 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
898
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200899stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
900 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
901 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
902 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +0200903 consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
904 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200905
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200906 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
907 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
908 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200909
910stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
911 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
912 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100913 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200914
915stats maxconn <connections>
916 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
917 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
918
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200919uid <number>
920 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
921 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
922 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
923 one. See also "gid" and "user".
924
925ulimit-n <number>
926 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
927 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
928 option.
929
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100930unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
931 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
932
933 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
934 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
935 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
936 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
937 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
938 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
939 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
940 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
941 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
942 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
943
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100944unsetenv [<name> ...]
945 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
946 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
947 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
948 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
949 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
950 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
951 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
952
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200953user <user name>
954 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
955 See also "uid" and "group".
956
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200957node <name>
958 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
959
960 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
961 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
962 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
963 traffic.
964
965description <text>
966 Add a text that describes the instance.
967
968 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
969 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
970 "<" and ">" characters.
971
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +010097251degrees-data-file <file path>
973 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
974 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevavnt permissions.
975
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200976 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100977 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
978
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000097951degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100980 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
981 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
982 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
983
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200984 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100985 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
986
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +020098751degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100988 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
989 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
990
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200991 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
992 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
993
99451degrees-cache-size <number>
995 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
996 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
997 By default, this cache is disabled.
998
999 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001000 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1001
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +01001002wurfl-data-file <file path>
1003 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1004 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1005
1006 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1007 with USE_WURFL=1.
1008
1009wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1010 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1011 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1012 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1013
1014 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1015
1016 Valid WURFL properties are:
1017 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1018
1019 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1020 device.
1021
1022 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1023 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1024
1025 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1026 particular web request.
1027
1028 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1029 used Libwurfl API version.
1030
1031 - wurfl_engine_target Contains a string representing the currently
1032 set WURFL Engine Target. Possible values are
1033 "HIGH_ACCURACY", "HIGH_PERFORMANCE", "INVALID".
1034
1035 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1036 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1037
1038 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1039 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1040
1041 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1042
1043 - wurfl_useragent_priority The user agent priority used by WURFL.
1044
1045 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1046 with USE_WURFL=1.
1047
1048wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1049 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1050 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1051
1052 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1053 with USE_WURFL=1.
1054
1055wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1056 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1057 thus before the chroot.
1058
1059 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1060 with USE_WURFL=1.
1061
1062wurfl-engine-mode { accuracy | performance }
1063 Sets the WURFL engine target. You can choose between 'accuracy' or
1064 'performance' targets. In performance mode, desktop web browser detection is
1065 done programmatically without referencing the WURFL data. As a result, most
1066 desktop web browsers are returned as generic_web_browser WURFL ID for
1067 performance. If either performance or accuracy are not defined, performance
1068 mode is enabled by default.
1069
1070 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1071 with USE_WURFL=1.
1072
1073wurfl-cache-size <U>[,<D>]
1074 Sets the WURFL caching strategy. Here <U> is the Useragent cache size, and
1075 <D> is the internal device cache size. There are three possibilities here :
1076 - "0" : no cache is used.
1077 - <U> : the Single LRU cache is used, the size is expressed in elements.
1078 - <U>,<D> : the Double LRU cache is used, both sizes are in elements. This is
1079 the highest performing option.
1080
1081 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1082 with USE_WURFL=1.
1083
1084wurfl-useragent-priority { plain | sideloaded_browser }
1085 Tells WURFL if it should prioritize use of the plain user agent ('plain')
1086 over the default sideloaded browser user agent ('sideloaded_browser').
1087
1088 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1089 with USE_WURFL=1.
1090
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001091
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010923.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001093-----------------------
1094
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001095max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1096 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1097 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1098 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1099 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1100 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1101 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1102 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1103 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1104
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001105maxconn <number>
1106 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1107 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1108 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001109 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1110 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1111 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1112 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001113 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will default to the value
1114 set in DEFAULT_MAXCONN at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) if no memory
1115 limit is enforced, or will be computed based on the memory limit, the buffer
1116 size, memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use or not of SSL
1117 and the associated maxsslconn (which can also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001118
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001119maxconnrate <number>
1120 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1121 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1122 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1123 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1124 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1125 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1126 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1127 fairness.
1128
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001129maxcomprate <number>
1130 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001131 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001132 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1133 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1134 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
1135 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
1136 default value.
1137
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001138maxcompcpuusage <number>
1139 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1140 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1141 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1142 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1143 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1144 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1145 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1146 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1147
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001148maxpipes <number>
1149 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1150 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1151 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1152 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1153 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1154 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1155
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001156maxsessrate <number>
1157 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1158 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1159 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1160 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1161 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1162 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1163 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1164 fairness.
1165
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001166maxsslconn <number>
1167 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1168 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1169 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1170 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1171 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1172 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1173 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001174 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1175 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1176 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1177 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1178 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1179 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1180 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001181
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001182maxsslrate <number>
1183 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1184 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1185 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1186 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1187 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1188 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1189 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1190 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1191 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1192 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1193
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001194maxzlibmem <number>
1195 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1196 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1197 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001198 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1199 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1200 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1201
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001202noepoll
1203 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1204 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001205 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001206
1207nokqueue
1208 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1209 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1210 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1211
1212nopoll
1213 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1214 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001215 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001216 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001217
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001218nosplice
1219 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
1220 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
1221 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001222 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001223 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1224 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1225 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1226 "option splice-response".
1227
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001228nogetaddrinfo
1229 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1230 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1231
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001232noreuseport
1233 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1234 command line argument "-dR".
1235
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001236spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001237 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1238 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1239 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1240 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1241 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1242 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001243
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001244tune.buffers.limit <number>
1245 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1246 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1247 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1248 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1249 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
1250 behaviour. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
1251 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1252 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1253 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1254 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1255 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1256 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1257 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1258 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1259 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1260
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001261tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1262 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1263 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1264 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1265 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1266
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001267tune.bufsize <number>
1268 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1269 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1270 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1271 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1272 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1273 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1274 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
1275 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001276 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
1277 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
1278 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001279
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001280tune.chksize <number>
1281 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1282 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1283 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1284 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1285 checks whenever possible.
1286
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001287tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1288 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1289 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1290 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1291 this value. The default value is 1.
1292
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001293tune.http.cookielen <number>
1294 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1295 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1296 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1297 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1298 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1299 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1300 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1301 to change this value.
1302
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001303tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1304 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1305 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1306 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1307 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1308 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1309 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
1310 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
1311 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
1312 limit too high.
1313
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001314tune.idletimer <timeout>
1315 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1316 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1317 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1318 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1319 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1320 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
1321 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (eg: read a page before
1322 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
1323 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1324
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001325tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1326 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001327 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001328 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1329 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
1330 executes some Lua code but more reactivity is required, this value can be
1331 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1332 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1333
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001334tune.lua.maxmem
1335 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1336 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1337 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1338 memory.
1339
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001340tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1341 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001342 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1343 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
1344 not taked in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001345
1346tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1347 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1348 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1349 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1350 check servers.
1351
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001352tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1353 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1354 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1355 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
1356 not taked in account. The default timeout is 4s.
1357
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001358tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001359 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1360 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1361 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1362 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1363 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1364 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1365 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1366 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1367 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1368 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001369
1370tune.maxpollevents <number>
1371 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1372 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1373 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1374 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1375 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1376
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001377tune.maxrewrite <number>
1378 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1379 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1380 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1381 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1382 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1383 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1384 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1385 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1386 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1387 bufsize.
1388
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001389tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1390 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1391 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1392 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1393 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1394 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1395 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1396 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1397 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1398 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
1399 about 5 MB on 32-bit systems and 8 MB on 64-bit systems. There is a very low
1400 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1401 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1402 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1403 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1404 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1405 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1406 setting this parameter to 0.
1407
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001408tune.pipesize <number>
1409 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1410 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1411 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1412 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1413 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1414 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1415
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001416tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1417tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1418 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1419 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1420 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1421 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1422 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1423 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1424 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1425
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001426tune.recv_enough <number>
1427 Haproxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
1428 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
1429 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
1430 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
1431 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
1432
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001433tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1434tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1435 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1436 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1437 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1438 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1439 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1440 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1441 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1442 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1443 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1444 notifying haproxy again.
1445
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001446tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001447 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1448 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1449 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001450 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001451 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
1452 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
1453 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1454 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1455 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001456 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1457 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001458
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001459tune.ssl.force-private-cache
1460 This boolean disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
1461 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1462 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1463 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1464 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1465 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1466
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001467tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1468 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001469 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001470 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1471 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1472 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1473 being used for too long.
1474
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001475tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1476 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1477 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1478 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1479 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1480 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1481 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1482 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1483 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1484 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1485 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001486 best value. Haproxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
1487 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001488
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001489tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1490 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1491 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1492 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1493 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1494 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1495 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1496 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001497 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
1498 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001499
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001500tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
1501 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
1502 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
1503 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
1504 1000 entries.
1505
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01001506tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
1507 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
1508 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
1509 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
1510
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001511tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001512tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001513tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
1514tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
1515tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001516 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
1517 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
1518 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
1519 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
1520 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
1521 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
1522 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
1523 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001524
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01001525 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
1526 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
1527 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
1528 all available space is consumed.
1529 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
1530 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
1531 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001532
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001533tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1534 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001535 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001536 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
1537 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
1538 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1539
1540tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1541 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1542 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
1543 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1544 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001545
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015463.3. Debugging
1547--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001548
1549debug
1550 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1551 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1552 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1553 system startup.
1554
1555quiet
1556 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1557 line argument "-q".
1558
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001559
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010015603.4. Userlists
1561--------------
1562It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1563http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1564it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1565
1566userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001567 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001568 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1569
1570group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001571 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001572 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1573 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1574
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001575user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1576 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001577 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1578 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001579 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
1580 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001581 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001582 DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001583
1584
1585 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001586 userlist L1
1587 group G1 users tiger,scott
1588 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001589
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001590 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1591 user scott insecure-password elgato
1592 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001593
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001594 userlist L2
1595 group G1
1596 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001597
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001598 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1599 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1600 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001601
1602 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001603
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001604
16053.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001606----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02001607It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
1608several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
1609instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
1610values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
1611automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
1612In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
1613using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
1614tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
1615reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
1616Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
1617that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
1618each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001619
1620peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001621 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001622 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1623
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02001624disabled
1625 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
1626 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
1627 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
1628
1629enable
1630 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
1631
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001632peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1633 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1634 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1635 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1636 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1637 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1638 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1639
1640 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1641 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1642
1643 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1644 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1645 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1646 across all peers.
1647
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001648 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1649 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001650
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001651 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001652 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001653 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1654 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1655 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001656
1657 backend mybackend
1658 mode tcp
1659 balance roundrobin
1660 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1661 stick on src
1662
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001663 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1664 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001665
1666
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090016673.6. Mailers
1668------------
1669It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
1670If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
1671in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
1672
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02001673mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001674 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
1675 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
1676
1677mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
1678 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
1679
1680 Example:
1681 mailers mymailers
1682 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
1683 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
1684
1685 backend mybackend
1686 mode tcp
1687 balance roundrobin
1688
1689 email-alert mailers mymailers
1690 email-alert from test1@horms.org
1691 email-alert to test2@horms.org
1692
1693 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1694 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
1695
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01001696timeout mail <time>
1697 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
1698 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
1699 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
1700 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
1701
1702 Example:
1703 mailers mymailers
1704 timeout mail 20s
1705 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001706
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017074. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001708----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001709
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001710Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02001711 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001712 - frontend <name>
1713 - backend <name>
1714 - listen <name>
1715
1716A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1717its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1718section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001719section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001720
1721A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1722connections.
1723
1724A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1725to forward incoming connections.
1726
1727A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1728parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1729
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001730All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1731'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1732case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1733
1734Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1735logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1736proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1737However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1738name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1739
1740Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1741and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001742bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001743protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1744modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1745arbitrary criteria.
1746
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001747In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
1748a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
1749the backend's. HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
1750
1751 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
1752 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
1753 between responses and new requests.
1754
1755 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
1756 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
1757 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
1758 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
1759
1760 - PCL: passive close ("option httpclose") : exactly the same as tunnel mode,
1761 but with "Connection: close" appended in both directions to try to make
1762 both ends close after the first request/response exchange.
1763
1764 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
1765 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
1766 client-facing connection remains open.
1767
1768 - FCL: forced close ("option forceclose") : the connection is actively closed
1769 after the end of the response.
1770
1771The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
1772frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
1773following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
1774weakest option and force close is the strongest.
1775
1776 Backend mode
1777
1778 | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1779 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1780 KAL | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1781 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1782 TUN | TUN | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1783 Frontend ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1784 mode PCL | PCL | PCL | PCL | FCL | FCL
1785 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1786 SCL | SCL | SCL | FCL | SCL | FCL
1787 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1788 FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL
1789
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001790
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001791
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017924.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1793--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001794
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001795The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1796limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1797they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1798limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001799marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001800option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02001801and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1802with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1803specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001804
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001805
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001806 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1807------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1808acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02001809appsession - - - -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001810backlog X X X -
1811balance X - X X
1812bind - X X -
1813bind-process X X X X
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02001814block (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001815capture cookie - X X -
1816capture request header - X X -
1817capture response header - X X -
1818clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001819compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001820contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1821cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02001822declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001823default-server X - X X
1824default_backend X X X -
1825description - X X X
1826disabled X X X X
1827dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001828email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09001829email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001830email-alert mailers X X X X
1831email-alert myhostname X X X X
1832email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001833enabled X X X X
1834errorfile X X X X
1835errorloc X X X X
1836errorloc302 X X X X
1837-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1838errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001839force-persist - X X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001840filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001841fullconn X - X X
1842grace X X X X
1843hash-type X - X X
1844http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001845http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001846http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001847http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02001848http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02001849http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02001850http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001851id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001852ignore-persist - X X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001853load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001854log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01001855log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001856log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001857log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02001858max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001859maxconn X X X -
1860mode X X X X
1861monitor fail - X X -
1862monitor-net X X X -
1863monitor-uri X X X -
1864option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1865option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1866option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1867option allbackups (*) X - X X
1868option checkcache (*) X - X X
1869option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1870option contstats (*) X X X -
1871option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1872option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1873option forceclose (*) X X X X
1874-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1875option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02001876option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02001877option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01001878option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001879option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001880option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001881option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01001882option http-tunnel (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001883option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1884option httpchk X - X X
1885option httpclose (*) X X X X
1886option httplog X X X X
1887option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001888option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001889option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001890option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001891option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1892option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1893option logasap (*) X X X -
1894option mysql-check X - X X
1895option nolinger (*) X X X X
1896option originalto X X X X
1897option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02001898option pgsql-check X - X X
1899option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001900option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001901option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001902option smtpchk X - X X
1903option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1904option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1905option splice-request (*) X X X X
1906option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01001907option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001908option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1909option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1910-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01001911option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001912option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1913option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1914option tcpka X X X X
1915option tcplog X X X X
1916option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001917external-check command X - X X
1918external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001919persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1920rate-limit sessions X X X -
1921redirect - X X X
1922redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1923redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1924reqadd - X X X
1925reqallow - X X X
1926reqdel - X X X
1927reqdeny - X X X
1928reqiallow - X X X
1929reqidel - X X X
1930reqideny - X X X
1931reqipass - X X X
1932reqirep - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001933reqitarpit - X X X
1934reqpass - X X X
1935reqrep - X X X
1936-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001937reqtarpit - X X X
1938retries X - X X
1939rspadd - X X X
1940rspdel - X X X
1941rspdeny - X X X
1942rspidel - X X X
1943rspideny - X X X
1944rspirep - X X X
1945rsprep - X X X
1946server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001947server-state-file-name X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001948source X - X X
1949srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02001950stats admin - X X X
1951stats auth X X X X
1952stats enable X X X X
1953stats hide-version X X X X
1954stats http-request - X X X
1955stats realm X X X X
1956stats refresh X X X X
1957stats scope X X X X
1958stats show-desc X X X X
1959stats show-legends X X X X
1960stats show-node X X X X
1961stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001962-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1963stick match - - X X
1964stick on - - X X
1965stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02001966stick store-response - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001967stick-table - - X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02001968tcp-check connect - - X X
1969tcp-check expect - - X X
1970tcp-check send - - X X
1971tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02001972tcp-request connection - X X -
1973tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02001974tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02001975tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02001976tcp-response content - - X X
1977tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001978timeout check X - X X
1979timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001980timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001981timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
1982timeout connect X - X X
1983timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1984timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
1985timeout http-request X X X X
1986timeout queue X - X X
1987timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02001988timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001989timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1990timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02001991timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001992transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01001993unique-id-format X X X -
1994unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001995use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02001996use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001997------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1998 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001999
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002000
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020014.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
2002---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002003
2004This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
2005
2006
2007acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
2008 Declare or complete an access list.
2009 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2010 no | yes | yes | yes
2011 Example:
2012 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2013 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2014 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002016 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002017
2018
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002019appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
2020 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002021 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
2022 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2023 no | no | yes | yes
2024 Arguments :
2025 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
2026 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
2027
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002028 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002029 checked in each cookie value.
2030
2031 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
2032 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
2033 milliseconds.
2034
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02002035 request-learn
2036 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
2037 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
2038 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
2039 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
2040 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
2041 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
2042
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002043 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
2044 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
2045 data following this prefix.
2046
2047 Example :
2048 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
2049
2050 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
2051 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
2052
2053 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
2054 2 modes are currently supported :
2055 - path-parameters :
2056 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
2057 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
2058 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
2059 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
2060 - query-string :
2061 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
2062 query string.
2063
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002064 As of version 1.6, appsessions was removed. It is more flexible and more
2065 convenient to use stick-tables instead, and stick-tables support multi-master
2066 replication and data conservation across reloads, which appsessions did not.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002067
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01002068 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
2069 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002070
2071
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002072backlog <conns>
2073 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2074 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2075 yes | yes | yes | no
2076 Arguments :
2077 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
2078 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002079 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002080
2081 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
2082 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
2083 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
2084 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
2085 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
2086 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
2087 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
2088 backlog parameter.
2089
2090 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
2091 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
2092 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
2093
2094 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
2095
2096
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002097balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002098balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002099 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
2100 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2101 yes | no | yes | yes
2102 Arguments :
2103 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
2104 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
2105 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
2106 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
2107
2108 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2109 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
2110 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2111 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002112 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002113 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002114 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2115 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2116 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2117 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2118 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2119 it, so that you don't worry.
2120
2121 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2122 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2123 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2124 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2125 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2126 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2127 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2128 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002129
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002130 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2131 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2132 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2133 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2134 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2135 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2136 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2137 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2138
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002139 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002140 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002141 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2142 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002143 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002144 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2145 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2146 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2147 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2148 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002149 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2150 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2151 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2152 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2153 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2154 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002155
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002156 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2157 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2158 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2159 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2160 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2161 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2162 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2163 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002164 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002165 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002166 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2167 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2168 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002169
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002170 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2171 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2172 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2173 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2174 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2175 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2176 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2177 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2178 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2179 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2180 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2181 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002182
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002183 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002184 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2185 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2186 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2187 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2188 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2189 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2190 URIs start with a leading "/".
2191
2192 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2193 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2194 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2195 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2196
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002197 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002198 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2199
2200 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002201 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2202 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002203 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2204 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2205 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2206 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002207 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002208 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2209 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002210
2211 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2212 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2213 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2214 server will receive the request.
2215
2216 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2217 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2218 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2219 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2220 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002221 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2222 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2223 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002224
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002225 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2226 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2227 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2228 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2229 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002230
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002231 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002232 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2233 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2234 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2235
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002236 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2237 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2238 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2239
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002240 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02002241 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002242 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
2243 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
2244 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
2245 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
2246 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
2247 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002248 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002249 used instead.
2250
2251 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
2252 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
2253 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
2254 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
2255
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002256 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2257 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2258 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2259
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002260 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09002261
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002262 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002263 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
2264 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002265
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01002266 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
2267 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
2268 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002269
2270 Examples :
2271 balance roundrobin
2272 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002273 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002274 balance hdr(User-Agent)
2275 balance hdr(host)
2276 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002277
2278 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
2279 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
2280
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002281 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002282 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
2283 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
2284 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
2285 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
2286
2287 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
2288 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
2289 defaults to 16 kB.
2290
2291 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
2292 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
2293
2294 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
2295 Round Robin.
2296
2297 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC2616 3.6.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
2298 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
2299 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
2300 actually appeared in the first chunk).
2301
2302 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
2303
2304 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002305 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002306 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
2307 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
2308 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002309
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002310 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002311
2312
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002313bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2314bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002315 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
2316 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2317 no | yes | yes | no
2318 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002319 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
2320 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
2321 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
2322 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01002323 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002324 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
2325 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
2326 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
2327 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
2328 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
2329 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
2330 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02002331 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
2332 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
2333 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
2334 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
2335 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
2336 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
2337 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01002338 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
2339 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
2340 be listening.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002341 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
2342 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
2343 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002344
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002345 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
2346 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002347 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
2348 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
2349 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002350 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
2351 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
2352 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
2353 the range.
2354
2355 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
2356 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
2357 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
2358 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
2359 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
2360 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
2361 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002362 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002363 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002364
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002365 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
2366 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
2367 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
2368 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
2369 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
2370 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
2371 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
2372 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
2373
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002374 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
2375 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
2376 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
2377 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002378
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002379 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
2380 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
2381 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
2382 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
2383 in a frontend.
2384
2385 Example :
2386 listen http_proxy
2387 bind :80,:443
2388 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002389 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002390
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002391 listen http_https_proxy
2392 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02002393 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002394
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002395 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
2396 bind ipv6@:80
2397 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
2398 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
2399
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002400 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002401 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002402
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02002403 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
2404 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
2405 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
2406 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
2407 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
2408
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002409 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002410 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002411
2412
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002413bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002414 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
2415 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2416 yes | yes | yes | yes
2417 Arguments :
2418 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
2419 may be used to override a default value.
2420
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002421 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002422 option may be combined with other numbers.
2423
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002424 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002425 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
2426 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
2427 missing from all processes.
2428
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002429 number The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002430 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02002431 the machine's word size. If a proxy is bound to process
2432 numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it will
2433 either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
2434 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002435
2436 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
2437 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
2438 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
2439 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
2440 and 'even' instances.
2441
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002442 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
2443 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
2444 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
2445 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002446
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002447 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
2448 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
2449
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02002450 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
2451 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
2452 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
2453
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002454 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
2455 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
2456
2457 Example :
2458 listen app_ip1
2459 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002460 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002461
2462 listen app_ip2
2463 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002464 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002465
2466 listen management
2467 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002468 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002469
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002470 listen management
2471 bind 10.0.0.4:80
2472 bind-process 1-4
2473
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002474 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002475
2476
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002477block { if | unless } <condition> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002478 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
2479 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2480 no | yes | yes | yes
2481
2482 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
2483 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002484 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02002485 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002486 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
2487 "block" statements per instance.
2488
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002489 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
2490 "http-request deny" instead.
2491
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002492 Example:
2493 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2494 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2495 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2496 block if invalid_src || local_dst
2497
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002498 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002499
2500
2501capture cookie <name> len <length>
2502 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
2503 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2504 no | yes | yes | no
2505 Arguments :
2506 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
2507 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
2508 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
2509 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
2510 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
2511
2512 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
2513 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
2514 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
2515 right if it exceeds <length>.
2516
2517 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
2518 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
2519 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
2520 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
2521
2522 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
2523 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
2524 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
2525
2526 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
2527 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
2528 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002529 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
2530 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
2531 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002532
2533 Example:
2534 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
2535
2536 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002537 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002538
2539
2540capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002541 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002542 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2543 no | yes | yes | no
2544 Arguments :
2545 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002546 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002547 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
2548 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2549 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2550
2551 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2552 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2553 it exceeds <length>.
2554
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002555 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002556 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
2557 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002558 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
2559 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
2560 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
2561 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002562 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002563 environments to find where the request came from.
2564
2565 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
2566 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
2567 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
2568 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002569
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002570 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
2571 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2572 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2573 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2574 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002575
2576 Example:
2577 capture request header Host len 15
2578 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01002579 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002580
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002581 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002582 about logging.
2583
2584
2585capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002586 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002587 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2588 no | yes | yes | no
2589 Arguments :
2590 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002591 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002592 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
2593 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2594 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2595
2596 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2597 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2598 it exceeds <length>.
2599
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002600 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002601 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
2602 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
2603 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002604 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
2605 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
2606 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
2607 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002608
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002609 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
2610 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2611 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2612 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2613 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002614
2615 Example:
2616 capture response header Content-length len 9
2617 capture response header Location len 15
2618
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002619 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002620 about logging.
2621
2622
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002623clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002624 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
2625 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2626 yes | yes | yes | no
2627 Arguments :
2628 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2629 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2630 as explained at the top of this document.
2631
2632 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
2633 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
2634 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
2635 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
2636 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
2637 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
2638 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
2639 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002640 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002641 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
2642 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
2643
2644 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
2645 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2646 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2647 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2648 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
2649 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2650
2651 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
2652 Please use "timeout client" instead.
2653
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01002654 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
2655 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002656
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002657compression algo <algorithm> ...
2658compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002659compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002660 Enable HTTP compression.
2661 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2662 yes | yes | yes | yes
2663 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002664 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
2665 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
2666 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
2667
2668 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002669 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
2670 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
2671 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002672
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002673 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002674 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002675
2676 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
2677 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
2678 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
2679 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
2680 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002681 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002682
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002683 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
2684 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
2685 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
2686 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
2687 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
2688 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
2689 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002690 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002691
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002692 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002693 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002694 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
2695 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
2696 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
2697 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
2698 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002699
2700 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
2701 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
2702 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
2703 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
2704 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002705 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
2706 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
2707 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
2708 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
2709 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02002710 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
2711 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002712
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002713 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002714 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
2715 "Accept-Encoding" header
2716 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01002717 * HTTP status code is not 200
William Lallemand8bb4e342013-12-10 17:28:48 +01002718 * response header "Transfer-Encoding" contains "chunked" (Temporary
2719 Workaround)
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002720 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
2721 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
2722 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
2723 "multipart"
2724 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
2725 header
2726 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
2727 and later
2728 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
2729 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002730
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002731 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
2732 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002733
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002734 Examples :
2735 compression algo gzip
2736 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002737
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002738
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002739contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002740 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2741 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2742 yes | no | yes | yes
2743 Arguments :
2744 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2745 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2746 as explained at the top of this document.
2747
2748 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002749 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002750 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002751 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
2752 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
2753 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
2754 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
2755
2756 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
2757 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2758 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2759 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2760 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
2761 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2762
2763 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
2764 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
2765 instead.
2766
2767 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
2768 "timeout server", "contimeout".
2769
2770
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02002771cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002772 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
2773 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002774 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
2775 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2776 yes | no | yes | yes
2777 Arguments :
2778 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
2779 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
2780 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
2781 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
2782 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
2783 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
2784 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
2785 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
2786 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
2787
2788 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
2789 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
2790 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
2791 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
2792 headers is left to the application. The application can then
2793 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01002794 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
2795 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
2796 behaviour is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
2797 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
2798 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002799
2800 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002801 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002802
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002803 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002804 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
2805 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
2806 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
2807 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
2808 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
2809 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
2810 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
2811 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
2812 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
2813 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002814
2815 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
2816 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
2817 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
2818 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
2819 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
2820 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
2821 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
2822 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
2823 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01002824 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002825 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
2826 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
2827 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002828
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002829 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
2830 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
2831 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002832 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
2833 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
2834 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
2835 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002836 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
2837 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
2838 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002839
2840 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
2841 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
2842 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
2843 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
2844 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
2845 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
2846 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
2847 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
2848 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
2849
2850 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
2851 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
2852 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
2853 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
2854 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
2855 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
2856 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
2857 persistence cookie in the cache.
2858 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
2859
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002860 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
2861 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
2862 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
2863 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
2864 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
2865 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
2866 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
2867 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
2868 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
2869 they logout.
2870
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002871 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
2872 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
2873 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
2874 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
2875
2876 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
2877 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
2878 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
2879 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
2880 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
2881 this attribute.
2882
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002883 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002884 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002885 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2886 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2887 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2888 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2889 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2890 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002891
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002892 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2893 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2894 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2895 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2896 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2897 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2898 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2899 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2900 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2901 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2902 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2903 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2904 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2905 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2906 the site.
2907
2908 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2909 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2910 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2911 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2912 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2913 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2914 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2915 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2916 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2917 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2918 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2919 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2920 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2921 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2922 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2923 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2924
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002925 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2926 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2927 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2928 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002929
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002930 Examples :
2931 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2932 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
2933 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002934 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002935
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002936 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002937
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002938
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002939declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
2940 Declares a capture slot.
2941 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2942 no | yes | yes | no
2943 Arguments:
2944 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
2945
2946 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
2947 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
2948 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
2949 for use in the response.
2950
2951 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02002952 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02002953 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
2954
2955
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002956default-server [param*]
2957 Change default options for a server in a backend
2958 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2959 yes | no | yes | yes
2960 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002961 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2962 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2963 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2964 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002965
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002966 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01002967 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
2968
2969 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002970
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01002971
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002972default_backend <backend>
2973 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
2974 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2975 yes | yes | yes | no
2976 Arguments :
2977 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
2978
2979 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
2980 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
2981 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
2982 will catch all undetermined requests.
2983
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002984 Example :
2985
2986 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
2987 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
2988 default_backend dynamic
2989
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02002990 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01002991
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002992
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02002993description <string>
2994 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
2995 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2996 no | yes | yes | yes
2997 Arguments : string
2998
2999 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
3000 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
3001 it describes.
3002 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
3003
3004
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003005disabled
3006 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3007 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3008 yes | yes | yes | yes
3009 Arguments : none
3010
3011 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
3012 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
3013 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
3014 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
3015 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
3016 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
3017 keyword in a "defaults" section.
3018
3019 See also : "enabled"
3020
3021
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003022dispatch <address>:<port>
3023 Set a default server address
3024 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3025 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003026 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003027
3028 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
3029 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
3030 during start-up.
3031
3032 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
3033 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
3034 possible with normal servers.
3035
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02003036 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003037 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
3038 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
3039 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
3040 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
3041
3042 See also : "server"
3043
3044
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003045enabled
3046 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3047 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3048 yes | yes | yes | yes
3049 Arguments : none
3050
3051 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
3052 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
3053
3054 See also : "disabled"
3055
3056
3057errorfile <code> <file>
3058 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3059 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3060 yes | yes | yes | yes
3061 Arguments :
3062 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
CJ Ess108b1dd2015-04-07 12:03:37 -04003063 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 429, 500, 502, 503, and
3064 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003065
3066 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003067 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003068 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003069 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3070 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003071
3072 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3073 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3074 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3075
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003076 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3077
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003078 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
3079 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
3080 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
3081 files returning the same contents as default errors.
3082
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003083 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
3084 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
3085 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
3086 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
3087 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
3088 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
3089
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003090 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
3091 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
3092 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003093 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003094 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
3095
3096 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
3097
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003098 Example :
3099 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003100 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003101 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
3102 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
3103
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003104
3105errorloc <code> <url>
3106errorloc302 <code> <url>
3107 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3108 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3109 yes | yes | yes | yes
3110 Arguments :
3111 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003112 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003113
3114 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3115 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3116 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3117 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
3118 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
3119
3120 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3121 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3122 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3123
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003124 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3125
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003126 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3127 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3128 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3129 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003130 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003131 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3132 request.
3133
3134 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3135
3136
3137errorloc303 <code> <url>
3138 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3139 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3140 yes | yes | yes | yes
3141 Arguments :
3142 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
3143 generating codes 400, 403, 408, 500, 502, 503, and 504.
3144
3145 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3146 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3147 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3148 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
3149 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
3150
3151 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3152 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3153 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3154
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003155 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3156
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003157 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3158 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3159 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3160 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003161 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003162
3163 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3164
3165
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003166email-alert from <emailaddr>
3167 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
3168 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
3169 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3170 yes | yes | yes | yes
3171
3172 Arguments :
3173
3174 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3175
3176 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3177 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3178
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003179 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003180 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3181 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003182
3183
3184email-alert level <level>
3185 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3186 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3187 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3188 yes | yes | yes | yes
3189
3190 Arguments :
3191
3192 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3193 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3194 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3195
3196 By default level is alert
3197
3198 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3199 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3200 for the proxy.
3201
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003202 Alerts are sent when :
3203
3204 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3205 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3206 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3207 is notice or lower
3208 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3209 and a health check status update occurs
3210
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003211 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3212 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003213 section 3.6 about mailers.
3214
3215
3216email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3217 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3218 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3219 yes | yes | yes | yes
3220
3221 Arguments :
3222
3223 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3224
3225 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3226 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3227
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003228 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3229 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003230
3231
3232email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3233 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3234 mailers.
3235 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3236 yes | yes | yes | yes
3237
3238 Arguments :
3239
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003240 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003241
3242 By default the systems hostname is used.
3243
3244 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3245 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3246 for the proxy.
3247
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003248 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3249 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003250
3251
3252email-alert to <emailaddr>
3253 Declare both the recipent address in the envelope and to address in the
3254 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3255 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3256 yes | yes | yes | yes
3257
3258 Arguments :
3259
3260 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3261
3262 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3263 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3264
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003265 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003266 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
3267
3268
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003269force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3270 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
3271 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3272 no | yes | yes | yes
3273
3274 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
3275 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
3276 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
3277 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
3278 marked down for maintenance operations.
3279
3280 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3281 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
3282 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
3283 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
3284 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
3285 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
3286 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
3287 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
3288 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
3289
3290 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3291 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
3292 is used.
3293
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003294 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003295 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003296
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003297
3298filter <name> [param*]
3299 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
3300 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3301 no | yes | yes | yes
3302 Arguments :
3303 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
3304 referenced in section 9.
3305
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003306 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003307 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003308 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
3309 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003310
3311 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
3312 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
3313
3314 Example:
3315 listen
3316 bind *:80
3317
3318 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
3319 filter compression
3320 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
3321
3322 compression algo gzip
3323 compression offload
3324
3325 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
3326
3327 See also : section 9.
3328
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003329
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003330fullconn <conns>
3331 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
3332 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3333 yes | no | yes | yes
3334 Arguments :
3335 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
3336 servers use the maximal number of connections.
3337
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003338 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003339 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003340 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003341 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
3342 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
3343 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
3344 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
3345 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003346 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003347
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003348 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
3349 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01003350 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
3351 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
3352 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003353
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003354 Example :
3355 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
3356 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
3357 # connections.
3358 backend dynamic
3359 fullconn 10000
3360 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3361 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3362
3363 See also : "maxconn", "server"
3364
3365
3366grace <time>
3367 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
3368 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01003369 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003370 Arguments :
3371 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
3372 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
3373 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
3374
3375 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
3376 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003377 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003378 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
3379
3380 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
3381 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
3382 simplify it.
3383
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003384
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003385hash-balance-factor <factor>
3386 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
3387 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3388 yes | no | no | yes
3389 Arguments :
3390 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
3391 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
3392 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
3393
3394 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
3395 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
3396 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
3397 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
3398 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
3399 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
3400 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
3401
3402 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
3403 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
3404 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
3405 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
3406 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
3407
3408 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
3409
3410
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003411hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003412 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
3413 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3414 yes | no | yes | yes
3415 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003416 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
3417 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003418
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003419 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
3420 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
3421 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
3422 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
3423 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
3424 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
3425 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
3426 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
3427 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
3428 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01003429
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003430 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
3431 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
3432 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
3433 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
3434 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
3435 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
3436 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
3437 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
3438 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
3439 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
3440 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
3441 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
3442 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003443 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
3444 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003445
3446 <function> is the hash function to be used :
3447
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003448 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003449 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
3450 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
3451 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003452 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
3453 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
3454 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003455
3456 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
3457 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003458 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
3459 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
3460 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
3461 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
3462
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01003463 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
3464 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
3465 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
3466 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
3467 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
3468 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
3469 parameter.
3470
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01003471 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
3472 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
3473 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
3474 used on strings.
3475
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003476 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
3477
3478 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
3479 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
3480 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
3481 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
3482 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
3483 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
3484 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
3485 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
3486 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
3487 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
3488 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
3489 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003490
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003491 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
3492 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
3493 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003494
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003495 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003496
3497
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003498http-check disable-on-404
3499 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
3500 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003501 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003502 Arguments : none
3503
3504 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
3505 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
3506 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
3507 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
3508 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
3509 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
3510 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
3511 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003512 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
3513 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
3514 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
3515
3516 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
3517
3518
3519http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003520 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003521 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02003522 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003523 Arguments :
3524 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
3525 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003526 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003527 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
3528 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
3529 details on the supported keywords.
3530
3531 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
3532 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
3533 with the usual backslash ('\').
3534
3535 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
3536 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
3537 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
3538 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
3539 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
3540
3541 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003542 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003543 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
3544 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3545 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3546
3547 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003548 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003549 response's status code matches the expression. If the
3550 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3551 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3552 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
3553
3554 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003555 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003556 response's body contains this exact string. If the
3557 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3558 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
3559 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
3560 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
3561 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
3562 trace).
3563
3564 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003565 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003566 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
3567 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
3568 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
3569 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
3570 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
3571 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
3572
3573 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
3574 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
3575 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
3576 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
3577 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
3578 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
3579 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
3580 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
3581
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01003582 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
3583 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
3584 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
3585
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003586 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
3587 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
3588
3589 Examples :
3590 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003591 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003592
3593 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003594 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003595
3596 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003597 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003598
3599 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003600 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*</html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003601
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003602 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003603
3604
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003605http-check send-state
3606 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
3607 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3608 yes | no | yes | yes
3609 Arguments : none
3610
3611 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
3612 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
3613 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
3614 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
3615 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
3616
3617 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
3618 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
3619 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
3620 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
3621 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08003622 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
3623 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
3624 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3625
3626 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
3627 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
3628 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3629
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003630 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
3631 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
3632 checked in multiple backends.
3633
3634 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
3635 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
3636
3637 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
3638 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
3639 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
3640 one fails.
3641
3642 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
3643 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
3644 connections on all servers of the same backend.
3645
3646 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
3647 server's queue.
3648
3649 Example of a header received by the application server :
3650 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
3651 scur=13/22; qcur=0
3652
3653 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
3654
Willy Tarreaube1d34d2016-06-26 19:37:59 +02003655http-request { allow | tarpit | auth [realm <realm>] | redirect <rule> |
3656 deny [deny_status <status>] |
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003657 add-header <name> <fmt> | set-header <name> <fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003658 capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ] |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003659 del-header <name> | set-nice <nice> | set-log-level <level> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003660 replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
3661 replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003662 set-method <fmt> | set-path <fmt> | set-query <fmt> |
3663 set-uri <fmt> | set-tos <tos> | set-mark <mark> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003664 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3665 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3666 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannbb7e86a2014-09-03 18:29:47 +02003667 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003668 set-var(<var name>) <expr> |
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01003669 unset-var(<var name>) |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003670 { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] |
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02003671 sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) |
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02003672 sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> |
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02003673 silent-drop |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003674 }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003675 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003676 Access control for Layer 7 requests
3677
3678 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3679 no | yes | yes | yes
3680
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003681 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3682 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3683 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3684 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3685 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003686
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003687 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3688 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request
3689 pass the check. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
3690
3691 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
Willy Tarreaube1d34d2016-06-26 19:37:59 +02003692 the request and emits an HTTP 403 error, or optionally the status code
3693 specified as an argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status
3694 codes is limited to those that can be overridden by the "errorfile"
3695 directive. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003696
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003697 - "tarpit" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks
3698 the request without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit"
3699 or "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the
3700 client is still connected, an HTTP error 500 is returned so that the
3701 client does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags
3702 "PT". The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack
3703 when they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
3704 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the
3705 load on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003706 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02003707 front firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections. See
3708 also the "silent-drop" action below.
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003709
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003710 - "auth" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds
3711 with an HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid
3712 user name and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An
3713 optional "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm
3714 that is returned with the response (typically the application's name).
3715
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003716 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
3717 This is exactly the same as the "redirect" statement except that it
3718 inserts a redirect rule which can be processed in the middle of other
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01003719 "http-request" rules and that these rules use the "log-format" strings.
3720 See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax.
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003721
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003722 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3723 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3724 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly
3725 useful to pass connection-specific information to the server (eg: the
3726 client's SSL certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This
3727 rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note
3728 that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
3729 the resulting header from a previous rule.
3730
3731 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3732 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3733 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
Willy Tarreau85603282015-01-21 20:39:27 +01003734 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so
3735 it is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003736
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003737 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3738 <name>.
3739
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003740 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
3741 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
3742 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
3743 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
3744 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
3745 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
3746 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
3747 in their value, such as If-Modified-Since and so on.
3748
3749 Example:
3750
3751 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
3752
3753 applied to:
3754
3755 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3756
3757 outputs:
3758
3759 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3760
3761 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
3762
3763 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3764 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3765 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3766 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3767 header.
3768
3769 Example:
3770
3771 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
3772
3773 applied to:
3774
3775 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3776
3777 outputs:
3778
3779 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3780
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003781 - "set-method" rewrites the request method with the result of the
3782 evaluation of format string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons
3783 for having to do so as this is more likely to break something than to fix
3784 it.
3785
3786 - "set-path" rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of
3787 format string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a
3788 scheme and authority is found before the path, they are left intact as
3789 well. If the request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with
3790 the format. This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of
3791 a path for example. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
3792
3793 Example :
3794 # prepend the host name before the path
3795 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
3796
3797 - "set-query" rewrites the request's query string which appears after the
3798 first question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format
3799 string <fmt>. The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the
3800 request doesn't contain a question mark and the new value is not empty,
3801 then one is added at the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If
3802 a question mark was present, it will never be removed even if the value
3803 is empty. This can be used to add or remove parameters from the query
3804 string. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
3805
3806 Example :
3807 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
3808 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
3809
3810 - "set-uri" rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of
3811 format string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all
3812 replaced at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies,
3813 or to perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts
3814 between the path and the query string. See also "set-path" and
3815 "set-query".
3816
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003817 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3818 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3819 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3820 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3821 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3822 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3823 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3824 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3825
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003826 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3827 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3828 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3829 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3830 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3831 another equipment.
3832
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003833 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3834 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3835 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3836 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3837 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3838 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3839 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3840 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3841
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003842 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3843 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3844 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3845 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3846 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3847 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3848 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3849 admin privileges.
3850
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003851 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3852 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3853 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3854 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3855 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3856 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3857 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3858 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3859
3860 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3861 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3862 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3863 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3864 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3865 can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3866
3867 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3868 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3869 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3870 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3871 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3872 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3873
3874 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3875 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3876 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3877 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3878 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3879 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3880 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3881 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3882 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3883
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003884 - capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ] :
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02003885 captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts
3886 it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
3887 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear
3888 next to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in
3889 the logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules
3890 to feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
3891 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
3892 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
3893 request header" for more information.
3894
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003895 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store
3896 the captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful
3897 to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous
3898 directive "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
Baptiste Assmanne9544932015-11-03 23:31:35 +01003899 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the
3900 configuration to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003901
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02003902 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
3903 enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules
3904 do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Three sets of
3905 counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The first
3906 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
3907 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
3908 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
3909 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
3910 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
3911 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
3912 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
3913 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
3914
3915 These actions take one or two arguments :
3916 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
3917 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
3918 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
3919 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
3920
3921 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
3922 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
3923 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
3924 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
3925
3926 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
3927 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
3928 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
3929 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
3930 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
3931 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
3932 been started. As an exception, connection counters and request counters
3933 are systematically updated so that they reflect useful information.
3934
3935 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
3936 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
3937 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
3938 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
3939 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
3940
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02003941 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
3942 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
3943 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
3944 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
3945 continues.
3946
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02003947 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
3948 This action increments the GPC0 counter according with the sticky counter
3949 designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and
3950 the actions evaluation continues.
3951
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003952 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr> :
3953 Is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
3954 inline.
3955
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01003956 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
3957 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01003958 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01003959 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
3960 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003961 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01003962 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003963 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01003964 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
3965 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003966 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01003967 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003968 and '_'.
3969
3970 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
3971 followed by some converters.
3972
3973 Example:
3974
3975 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
3976
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01003977 - unset-var(<var-name>) :
3978 Is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
3979
3980 Example:
3981
3982 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
3983
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02003984 - set-src <expr> :
3985 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
3986 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP,
3987 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask
3988 source IP for privacy.
3989
3990 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
3991 followed by some converters.
3992
3993 Example:
3994
3995 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
3996 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
3997
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02003998 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
3999 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004000
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004001 - set-src-port <expr> :
4002 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
4003 expression.
4004
4005 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4006 followed by some converters.
4007
4008 Example:
4009
4010 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
4011 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
4012
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004013 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
4014 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
4015 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004016
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004017 - set-dst <expr> :
4018 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
4019 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination
4020 IP, but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask
4021 the IP for privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
4022 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
4023
4024 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4025 followed by some converters.
4026
4027 Example:
4028
4029 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
4030 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
4031
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004032 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
4033 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
4034
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004035 - set-dst-port <expr> :
4036 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
4037 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
4038 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
4039
4040 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4041 followed by some converters.
4042
4043 Example:
4044
4045 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
4046 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
4047
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004048 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
4049 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
4050 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
4051
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004052 - "silent-drop" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the
4053 client-facing connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way
4054 that tries to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then
4055 that the client still sees an established connection while there's none
4056 on HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
4057 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
4058 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and slow
4059 down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact of using
4060 this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the client and
4061 HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep the
4062 established connection for a long time and may suffer from this action.
4063 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR
4064 socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other
4065 systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't
4066 pass the first router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do
4067 not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
4068
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004069 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
4070
4071 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
4072 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004073 or "reqadd" rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are
4074 visible by almost all further ACL rules.
4075
4076 Using "reqadd"/"reqdel"/"reqrep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4077 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4078 delete headers, you can still use "reqdel". Also please use
4079 "http-request deny/allow/tarpit" instead of "reqdeny"/"reqpass"/"reqtarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004080
4081 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004082 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
4083 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
4084 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004085
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004086 http-request allow if nagios
4087 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
4088 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
4089 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004090
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004091 Example:
4092 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004093 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004094
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004095 Example:
4096 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
4097 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
Willy Tarreaufca42612015-08-27 17:15:05 +02004098 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004099 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
4100 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
4101 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
4102 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
4103 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
4104 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
4105
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004106 Example:
4107 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
4108 acl add path /addacl
4109 acl del path /delacl
4110
4111 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
4112
4113 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
4114 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
4115
4116 Example:
4117 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4118 acl setmap path /setmap
4119 acl delmap path /delmap
4120
4121 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
4122
4123 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
4124 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
4125
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02004126 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
4127 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004128
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004129http-response { allow | deny | add-header <name> <fmt> | set-nice <nice> |
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02004130 capture <sample> id <id> | redirect <rule> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004131 set-header <name> <fmt> | del-header <name> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004132 replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
4133 replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
Robin H. Johnson52f5db22017-01-01 13:10:52 -08004134 set-status <status> [reason <str>] |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004135 set-log-level <level> | set-mark <mark> | set-tos <tos> |
4136 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
4137 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
4138 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01004139 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004140 set-var(<var-name>) <expr> |
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004141 unset-var(<var-name>) |
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08004142 { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] |
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004143 sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) |
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004144 sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> |
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004145 silent-drop |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004146 }
Lukas Tribus2dd1d1a2013-06-19 23:34:41 +02004147 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004148 Access control for Layer 7 responses
4149
4150 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4151 no | yes | yes | yes
4152
4153 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4154 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4155 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4156 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4157 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4158 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4159
4160 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
4161 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response
4162 pass the check. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the
4163 current section.
4164
4165 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
4166 the response and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response"
4167 rules are evaluated.
4168
4169 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
4170 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
4171 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send
4172 a cookie to a client for example, or to pass some internal information.
4173 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4174 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might
4175 reuse the resulting header from a previous rule.
4176
4177 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
4178 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
4179 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
4180 external users.
4181
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004182 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
4183 <name>.
4184
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004185 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
4186 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
4187 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
4188 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
4189 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
4190 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
4191 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
4192 in their value, such as Set-Cookie, Expires and so on.
4193
4194 Example:
4195
4196 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
4197
4198 applied to:
4199
4200 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4201
4202 outputs:
4203
4204 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4205
4206 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
4207
4208 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
4209 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
4210 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
4211 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
4212 header.
4213
4214 Example:
4215
4216 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
4217
4218 applied to:
4219
4220 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
4221
4222 outputs:
4223
4224 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
4225
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004226 - "set-status" replaces the response status code with <status> which must
Robin H. Johnson52f5db22017-01-01 13:10:52 -08004227 be an integer between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be
4228 provided defined by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code
4229 will be used as a fallback.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004230
4231 Example:
4232
4233 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
4234 http-response set-status 431
Robin H. Johnson52f5db22017-01-01 13:10:52 -08004235 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
4236 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004237
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004238 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
4239 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
4240 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
4241 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
4242 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
4243 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
4244 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
4245 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
4246
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004247 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
4248 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
4249 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
4250 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
4251 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
4252 another equipment.
4253
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004254 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
4255 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
4256 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
4257 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
4258 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
4259 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
4260 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
4261 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4262
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004263 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
4264 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
4265 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
4266 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
4267 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
4268 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
4269 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
4270 admin privileges.
4271
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004272 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
4273 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
4274 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4275 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
4276 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4277 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4278 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
4279 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4280
4281 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
4282 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
4283 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4284 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4285 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
4286 can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4287
4288 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
4289 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
4290 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4291 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4292 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4293 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4294
4295 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
4296 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
4297 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
4298 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
4299 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
4300 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4301 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4302 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
4303 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4304
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004305 - capture <sample> id <id> :
4306 captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and converts
4307 it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
4308 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
4309 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
4310 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
4311 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
4312 response header" for more information.
4313
4314 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing
4315 the string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
4316 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by
4317 a previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
4318 keyword.
Baptiste Assmanne9544932015-11-03 23:31:35 +01004319 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the
4320 configuration to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004321
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02004322 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
4323 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
4324 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible
4325 on the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When
4326 a redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server
4327 are closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
4328
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004329 - set-var(<var-name>) expr:
4330 Is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4331 inline.
4332
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004333 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
4334 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01004335 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004336 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4337 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004338 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004339 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004340 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004341 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4342 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004343 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01004344 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
4345 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004346
4347 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4348 followed by some converters.
4349
4350 Example:
4351
4352 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
4353
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004354 - unset-var(<var-name>) :
4355 Is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
4356
4357 Example:
4358
4359 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
4360
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08004361 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
4362 enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer to
4363 "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
4364 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make
4365 use of samples in response (eg. res.*, status etc.) and samples below
4366 Layer 6 (eg. ssl related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is
4367 not supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
4368
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004369 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
4370 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
4371 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
4372 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
4373 continues.
4374
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004375 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
4376 This action increments the GPC0 counter according with the sticky counter
4377 designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and
4378 the actions evaluation continues.
4379
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004380 - "silent-drop" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the
4381 client-facing connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way
4382 that tries to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then
4383 that the client still sees an established connection while there's none
4384 on HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
4385 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
4386 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and slow
4387 down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact of using
4388 this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the client and
4389 HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep the
4390 established connection for a long time and may suffer from this action.
4391 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR
4392 socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other
4393 systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't
4394 pass the first router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do
4395 not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
4396
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004397 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
4398
Godbach09250262013-07-02 01:19:15 +08004399 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004400 the HTTP processing, before "rspdel" or "rsprep" or "rspadd" rules. That way,
4401 headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further ACL
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004402 rules.
4403
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004404 Using "rspadd"/"rspdel"/"rsprep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4405 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4406 delete headers, you can still use "rspdel". Also please use
4407 "http-response deny" instead of "rspdeny".
4408
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004409 Example:
4410 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
4411
4412 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
4413
4414 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4415 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4416
4417 Example:
4418 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4419
4420 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
4421
4422 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
4423 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
4424
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004425 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
4426 ACL usage.
4427
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02004428
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004429http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
4430 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
4431
4432 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4433 yes | no | yes | yes
4434
4435 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
4436 belongs to the session that initiated it. The downside is that between the
4437 response and the next request, the connection remains idle and is not used.
4438 In many cases for performance reasons it is desirable to make it possible to
4439 reuse these idle connections to serve other requests from different sessions.
4440 This directive allows to tune this behaviour.
4441
4442 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
4443
4444 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This is
4445 the default choice. It may be enforced to cancel a different
4446 strategy inherited from a defaults section or for
4447 troubleshooting. For example, if an old bogus application
4448 considers that multiple requests over the same connection come
4449 from the same client and it is not possible to fix the
4450 application, it may be desirable to disable connection sharing
4451 in a single backend. An example of such an application could
4452 be an old haproxy using cookie insertion in tunnel mode and
4453 not checking any request past the first one.
4454
4455 - "safe" : this is the recommended strategy. The first request of a
4456 session is always sent over its own connection, and only
4457 subsequent requests may be dispatched over other existing
4458 connections. This ensures that in case the server closes the
4459 connection when the request is being sent, the browser can
4460 decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly equivalent to
4461 regular keep-alive, there should be no side effects.
4462
4463 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
4464 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
4465 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
4466 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
4467 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
4468 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
4469 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
4470 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
4471 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweights the
4472 downsides of rare connection failures.
4473
4474 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
4475 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
4476 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
4477 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
4478 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
4479 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
4480 consistent behaviour and will benefit from the connection
4481 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
4482 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
4483 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
4484 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
4485 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
4486
4487 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
4488 connection properties and compatiblities. Specifically :
4489 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependant value
4490 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared ;
4491
4492 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
4493 and are never shared ;
4494
4495 - connections receiving a status code 401 or 407 expect some authentication
4496 to be sent in return. Due to certain bogus authentication schemes (such
4497 as NTLM) relying on the connection, these connections are marked private
4498 and are never shared ;
4499
4500 No connection pool is involved, once a session dies, the last idle connection
4501 it was attached to is deleted at the same time. This ensures that connections
4502 may not last after all sessions are closed.
4503
4504 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
4505 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
4506 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
4507
4508 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
4509
4510
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05004511http-send-name-header [<header>]
4512 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
4513
4514 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4515 yes | no | yes | yes
4516
4517 Arguments :
4518
4519 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
4520
4521 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
4522 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
4523 is added with the header string proved.
4524
4525 See also : "server"
4526
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01004527id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02004528 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
4529 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4530 no | yes | yes | yes
4531 Arguments : none
4532
4533 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
4534 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
4535 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01004536
4537
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004538ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4539 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
4540 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4541 no | yes | yes | yes
4542
4543 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
4544 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
4545 and running).
4546
4547 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
4548 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
4549 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004550 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004551 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
4552
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004553 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
4554 "unless" condition is met.
4555
4556 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
4557
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004558load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
4559 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
4560 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4561 yes | no | yes | yes
4562
4563 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
4564 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
4565 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
4566 reload occured. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
4567 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
4568 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
4569 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
4570 over the stats socket and redirect output.
4571
4572 The format of the file is versionned and is very specific. To understand it,
4573 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02004574 9.2 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004575
4576 Arguments:
4577 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
4578 named "server-state-file".
4579
4580 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
4581 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
4582 name is used as a file name.
4583
4584 none don't load any stat for this backend
4585
4586 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01004587 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
4588 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
4589 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
4590 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (eg: /etc/hosts)
4591 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004592
4593 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
4594 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
4595
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004596 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004597
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004598 global
4599 stats socket /tmp/socket
4600 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004601
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004602 defaults
4603 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004604
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004605 backend bk
4606 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
4607 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004608
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004609
4610 Then one can run :
4611
4612 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
4613
4614 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
4615
4616 1
4617 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
4618 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4619 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4620
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004621 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004622
4623 global
4624 stats socket /tmp/socket
4625 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
4626
4627 defaults
4628 load-server-state-from-file local
4629
4630 backend bk
4631 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
4632 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
4633
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004634
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004635 Then one can run :
4636
4637 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
4638
4639 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
4640
4641 1
4642 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
4643 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4644 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4645
4646 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
4647 "show servers state"
4648
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004649
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004650log global
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02004651log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004652no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004653 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
4654 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4655 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004656
4657 Prefix :
4658 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
4659 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
4660 prefix does not allow arguments.
4661
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004662 Arguments :
4663 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
4664 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
4665 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
4666 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
4667 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
4668 parameter.
4669
4670 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
4671 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
4672
4673 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
4674 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
4675 standard syslog port).
4676
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01004677 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
4678 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
4679 standard syslog port).
4680
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004681 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
4682 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
4683 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
4684 appropriately writeable).
4685
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004686 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
4687 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004688
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02004689 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
4690 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
4691 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
4692 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
4693 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
4694 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
4695 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
4696 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
4697 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
4698 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
4699 long captures or JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
4700
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004701 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
4702
4703 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
4704 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
4705 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
4706
4707 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
4708 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
4709 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02004710 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
4711 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
4712 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
4713 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
4714 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004715
4716 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4717
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004718 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
4719 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
4720 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004721
4722 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
4723 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
4724 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
4725 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
4726
4727 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
4728 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004729
4730 Example :
4731 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02004732 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
4733 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004734 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004735
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004736
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004737log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01004738 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
4739 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4740 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004741
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01004742 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
4743 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
4744 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
4745 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
4746 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004747
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02004748log-format-sd <string>
4749 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
4750 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4751 yes | yes | yes | no
4752
4753 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
4754 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
4755 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
4756 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
4757 which covers the log format string in depth.
4758
4759 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
4760 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
4761
4762 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
4763 log format to "rfc5424".
4764
4765 Example :
4766 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
4767
4768
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01004769log-tag <string>
4770 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
4771 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4772 yes | yes | yes | yes
4773
4774 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
4775 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
4776 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
4777 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
4778 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
4779 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
4780 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
4781 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
4782 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004783
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02004784max-keep-alive-queue <value>
4785 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
4786 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4787 yes | no | yes | yes
4788
4789 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
4790 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
4791 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
4792 servers.
4793
4794 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
4795 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
4796 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
4797 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
4798 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
4799 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (eg: local static server can
4800 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
4801 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
4802 picking a different server.
4803
4804 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
4805 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
4806 even if they have to be queued.
4807
4808 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
4809 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
4810
4811
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004812maxconn <conns>
4813 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
4814 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4815 yes | yes | yes | no
4816 Arguments :
4817 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
4818 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
4819 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
4820 closes.
4821
4822 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
4823 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
4824 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
4825 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01004826 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
4827 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
4828 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
4829 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004830
4831 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
4832 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
4833 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
4834
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02004835 By default, this value is set to 2000.
4836
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004837 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
4838
4839
4840mode { tcp|http|health }
4841 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
4842 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4843 yes | yes | yes | yes
4844 Arguments :
4845 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
4846 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
4847 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
4848 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
4849
4850 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
4851 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
4852 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
4853 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
4854 brings HAProxy most of its value.
4855
4856 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004857 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
4858 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
4859 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
4860 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
4861 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
4862 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
4863 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004864
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004865 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
4866 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
4867 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004868
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004869 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004870 defaults http_instances
4871 mode http
4872
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004873 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004874
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004875
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01004876monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004877 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004878 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4879 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004880 Arguments :
4881 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
4882 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004883 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004884 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
4885 backend and its backup.
4886
4887 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
4888 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
4889 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
4890 servers in a list of backends.
4891
4892 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
4893 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
4894 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
4895 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
4896 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
4897 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
4898 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004899 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
4900 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004901
4902 Example:
4903 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004904 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004905 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
4906 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
4907 monitor-uri /site_alive
4908 monitor fail if site_dead
4909
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004910 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004911
4912
4913monitor-net <source>
4914 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
4915 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4916 yes | yes | yes | no
4917 Arguments :
4918 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
4919 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
4920 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
4921 followed by a mask.
4922
4923 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
4924 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004925 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004926 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
4927
4928 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
4929 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
4930 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
4931 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004932 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
4933 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
4934 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004935
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004936 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
4937 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
4938 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
4939 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
4940 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
4941 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004942
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01004943 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
4944 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004945
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004946 Example :
4947 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
4948 frontend www
4949 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
4950
4951 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
4952
4953
4954monitor-uri <uri>
4955 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
4956 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4957 yes | yes | yes | no
4958 Arguments :
4959 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
4960 health status instead of forwarding the request.
4961
4962 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
4963 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
4964 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
4965 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
4966 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
4967 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
4968 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
4969 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
4970
4971 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
4972 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
4973 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
4974 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
4975 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
4976 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
4977
4978 Example :
4979 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
4980 frontend www
4981 mode http
4982 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
4983
4984 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
4985
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004986
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004987option abortonclose
4988no option abortonclose
4989 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
4990 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4991 yes | no | yes | yes
4992 Arguments : none
4993
4994 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
4995 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
4996 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
4997 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004998 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01004999 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
5000 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
5001 encountered while delivering the response.
5002
5003 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
5004 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
5005 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
5006 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
5007 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
5008 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005009 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005010 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005011 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005012 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
5013 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
5014 still not served and not pollute the servers.
5015
5016 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
5017 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
5018 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
5019 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
5020 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
5021 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
5022 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
5023 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005024 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005025
5026 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5027 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5028
5029 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
5030
5031
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005032option accept-invalid-http-request
5033no option accept-invalid-http-request
5034 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
5035 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5036 yes | yes | yes | no
5037 Arguments : none
5038
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005039 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005040 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
5041 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
5042 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5043 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5044 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5045 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5046 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005047 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
5048 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
5049 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
5050 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
5051 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005052 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02005053 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
5054 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
5055 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005056
5057 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5058 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5059 been confirmed.
5060
5061 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5062 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005063 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
5064 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005065 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5066
5067 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5068 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5069
5070 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
5071 stats socket.
5072
5073
5074option accept-invalid-http-response
5075no option accept-invalid-http-response
5076 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
5077 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5078 yes | no | yes | yes
5079 Arguments : none
5080
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005081 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005082 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
5083 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
5084 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5085 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5086 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5087 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5088 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005089 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
5090 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
5091 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005092
5093 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5094 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5095 been confirmed.
5096
5097 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5098 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
5099 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
5100 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5101
5102 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5103 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5104
5105 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
5106 stats socket.
5107
5108
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005109option allbackups
5110no option allbackups
5111 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
5112 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5113 yes | no | yes | yes
5114 Arguments : none
5115
5116 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
5117 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
5118 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
5119 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
5120 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
5121 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
5122 order between the backup servers anymore.
5123
5124 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
5125 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
5126
5127 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5128 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5129
5130
5131option checkcache
5132no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08005133 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005134 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5135 yes | no | yes | yes
5136 Arguments : none
5137
5138 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
5139 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005140 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005141 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
5142 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005143 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005144
5145 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005146 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005147 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005148 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
5149 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005150 to the client are :
5151 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005152 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005153 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005154 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
5155 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
5156 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
5157 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
5158 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
5159 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
5160 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
5161 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
5162 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
5163 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
5164 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
5165
5166 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005167 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005168 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005169 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005170 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
5171
5172 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
5173 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005174 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005175 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
5176
5177 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5178 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5179
5180
5181option clitcpka
5182no option clitcpka
5183 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
5184 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5185 yes | yes | yes | no
5186 Arguments : none
5187
5188 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5189 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5190 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5191 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5192
5193 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5194 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5195 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5196 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5197
5198 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5199 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5200 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5201 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5202 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5203
5204 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5205
5206 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
5207 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
5208 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
5209
5210 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5211 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5212
5213 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
5214
5215
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005216option contstats
5217 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
5218 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5219 yes | yes | yes | no
5220 Arguments : none
5221
5222 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
5223 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
5224 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
5225 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01005226 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
5227 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
5228 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
5229 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
5230 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005231
5232
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005233option dontlog-normal
5234no option dontlog-normal
5235 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
5236 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5237 yes | yes | yes | no
5238 Arguments : none
5239
5240 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
5241 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
5242 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
5243 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
5244 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
5245 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
5246 logged.
5247
5248 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
5249 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
5250 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
5251
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005252 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005253 logging.
5254
5255
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005256option dontlognull
5257no option dontlognull
5258 Enable or disable logging of null connections
5259 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5260 yes | yes | yes | no
5261 Arguments : none
5262
5263 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
5264 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
5265 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
5266 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
5267 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
5268 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005269 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
5270 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
5271 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005272
5273 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
5274 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
5275 would not be logged.
5276
5277 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5278 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5279
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005280 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
5281 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005282
5283
5284option forceclose
5285no option forceclose
5286 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
5287 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01005288 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005289 Arguments : none
5290
5291 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
5292 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
5293 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
5294 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
5295 global session times in the logs.
5296
5297 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01005298 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005299 to respond and release some resources earlier than with "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005300
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005301 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
5302 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
5303 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
5304
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005305 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
5306 http-server-close", "option http-keep-alive", or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005307
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005308 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5309 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5310
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005311 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005312
5313
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005314option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005315 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
5316 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5317 yes | yes | yes | yes
5318 Arguments :
5319 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
5320 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005321 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005322 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005323
5324 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
5325 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
5326 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
5327 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
5328 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
5329 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
5330 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005331 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
5332 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
5333 possible that the client has already brought one.
5334
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005335 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005336 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005337 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
5338 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005339 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
5340 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005341
5342 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
5343 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
5344 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
5345 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
5346 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
5347 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
5348 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
5349
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005350 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
5351 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
5352 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
5353 are under the control of the end-user.
5354
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005355 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005356 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
5357 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005358 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
5359 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
5360 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005361
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005362 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005363 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
5364 frontend www
5365 mode http
5366 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
5367
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005368 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
5369 backend www
5370 mode http
5371 option forwardfor header X-Client
5372
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005373 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005374 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005375
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005376
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005377option http-buffer-request
5378no option http-buffer-request
5379 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
5380 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5381 yes | yes | yes | yes
5382 Arguments : none
5383
5384 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
5385 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
5386 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
5387 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
5388 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
5389 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
5390 body is received, or the request buffer is full, or the first chunk is
5391 complete in case of chunked encoding. It can have undesired side effects with
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005392 some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered transmissions between
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005393 the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely not be used by
5394 default.
5395
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01005396 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005397
5398
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005399option http-ignore-probes
5400no option http-ignore-probes
5401 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
5402 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5403 yes | yes | yes | no
5404 Arguments : none
5405
5406 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
5407 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
5408 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
5409 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
5410 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
5411 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
5412 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
5413 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
5414 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
5415 was received over a connection before it was closed ;
5416 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation ;
5417 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
5418
5419 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
5420 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
5421 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
5422 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
5423 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
5424 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
5425 are often the only way to detect them.
5426
5427 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5428 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5429
5430 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
5431
5432
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005433option http-keep-alive
5434no option http-keep-alive
5435 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
5436 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5437 yes | yes | yes | yes
5438 Arguments : none
5439
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005440 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5441 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5442 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
5443 start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such as
5444 "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5445 "option http-tunnel". This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode,
5446 which can be useful when another mode was used in a defaults section.
5447
5448 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
5449 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005450 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
5451 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
5452 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
5453 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
5454 situations where this option may be useful :
5455
5456 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
5457 instead of requests (eg: NTLM authentication)
5458
5459 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
5460 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
5461
5462 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
5463 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
5464 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
5465 request.
5466
5467 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
5468 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005469 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
5470 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
5471 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005472
5473 In general it is preferred to use "option http-server-close" with application
5474 servers, and some static servers might benefit from "option http-keep-alive".
5475
5476 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
5477 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
5478 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
5479 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
5480 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
5481 not set.
5482
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005483 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
5484 http-server-close", "option forceclose" or "option http-tunnel". When backend
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005485 and frontend options differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005486 "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005487
5488 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005489 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
5490 "option httpclose", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005491
5492
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02005493option http-no-delay
5494no option http-no-delay
5495 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
5496 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5497 yes | yes | yes | yes
5498 Arguments : none
5499
5500 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
5501 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
5502 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
5503 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
5504 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
5505 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
5506 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
5507 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
5508 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
5509 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
5510 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
5511 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
5512 affected.
5513
5514 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
5515 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
5516 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
5517 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
5518 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
5519 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
5520 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
5521 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
5522 latency environments.
5523
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005524 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
5525
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02005526
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005527option http-pretend-keepalive
5528no option http-pretend-keepalive
5529 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
5530 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5531 yes | yes | yes | yes
5532 Arguments : none
5533
5534 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
5535 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
5536 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
5537 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
5538 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
5539 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
5540 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
5541 consider the response complete.
5542
5543 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
5544 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
5545 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
5546 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
5547 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
5548 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
5549
5550 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
5551 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
5552 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
5553 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
5554 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
5555 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
5556 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
5557
5558 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5559 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005560 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02005561 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
5562 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005563
5564 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5565 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5566
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005567 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close", and
5568 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005569
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005570
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005571option http-server-close
5572no option http-server-close
5573 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
5574 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5575 yes | yes | yes | yes
5576 Arguments : none
5577
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005578 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5579 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5580 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5581 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
5582 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5583 "option http-tunnel". Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP
5584 connection-close mode on the server side while keeping the ability to support
5585 HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest
5586 latency on the client side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on
5587 the server side to save server resources, similarly to "option forceclose".
5588 It also permits non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode
5589 to the clients if they conform to the requirements of RFC2616. Please note
5590 that some servers do not always conform to those requirements when they see
5591 "Connection: close" in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will
5592 never be used. A workaround consists in enabling "option
5593 http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005594
5595 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
5596 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
5597 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
5598 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01005599 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
5600 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005601
5602 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5603 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005604 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option forceclose",
5605 "option http-tunnel" or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005606 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
5607 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005608
5609 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5610 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5611
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02005612 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005613 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
5614 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005615
5616
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005617option http-tunnel
5618no option http-tunnel
5619 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction
5620 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5621 yes | yes | yes | yes
5622 Arguments : none
5623
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005624 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5625 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5626 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5627 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
5628 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5629 "option http-tunnel".
5630
5631 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005632 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005633 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
5634 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
5635 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
5636 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
5637 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
5638 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
5639 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005640
5641 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5642 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5643
5644 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
5645 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
5646 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
5647
5648
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005649option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005650no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005651 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
5652 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5653 yes | yes | yes | no
5654 Arguments : none
5655
5656 While RFC2616 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
5657 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
5658 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
5659 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
5660 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
5661 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
5662 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
5663
5664 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
5665 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01005666 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
5667 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
5668 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005669
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01005670 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
5671 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
5672 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
5673 front of an existing proxy.
5674
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005675 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
5676
5677 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
5678 http-server-close".
5679
5680
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005681option httpchk
5682option httpchk <uri>
5683option httpchk <method> <uri>
5684option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
5685 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
5686 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5687 yes | no | yes | yes
5688 Arguments :
5689 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
5690 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
5691 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
5692 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
5693 ones.
5694
5695 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
5696 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5697 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5698
5699 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
5700 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
5701 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
5702 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
5703 after "\r\n" following the version string.
5704
5705 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
5706 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
5707 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
5708 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
5709 the lack of any response.
5710
5711 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
5712
5713 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
5714 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
5715 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
5716
5717 Examples :
5718 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
5719 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
5720 backend https_relay
5721 mode tcp
5722 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
5723 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
5724
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09005725 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
5726 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
5727 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005728
5729
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005730option httpclose
5731no option httpclose
5732 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
5733 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5734 yes | yes | yes | yes
5735 Arguments : none
5736
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005737 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5738 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5739 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5740 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005741 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005742 "option http-tunnel".
5743
5744 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will work in HTTP tunnel mode and check
5745 if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction, and will
5746 add one if missing. Each end should react to this by actively closing the TCP
5747 connection after each transfer, thus resulting in a switch to the HTTP close
5748 mode. Any "Connection" header different from "close" will also be removed.
5749 Note that this option is deprecated since what it does is very cheap but not
5750 reliable. Using "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose" is strongly
5751 recommended instead.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005752
5753 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005754 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01005755 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
5756 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
5757 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
5758 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
5759 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005760
5761 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5762 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005763 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
5764 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005765 check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when
5766 frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005767
5768 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5769 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5770
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02005771 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
5772 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005773
5774
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005775option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005776 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
5777 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5778 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005779 Arguments :
5780 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
5781 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
5782 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
5783 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
5784 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005785
5786 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
5787 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
5788 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
5789 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
5790 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
5791 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
5792 ports.
5793
5794 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
5795
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01005796 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
5797 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005798
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005799 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005800
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005801
5802option http_proxy
5803no option http_proxy
5804 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
5805 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5806 yes | yes | yes | yes
5807 Arguments : none
5808
5809 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
5810 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
5811 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
5812 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
5813 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
5814
5815 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
5816 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01005817 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
5818 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005819
5820 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5821 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5822
5823 Example :
5824 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
5825 backend direct_forward
5826 option httpclose
5827 option http_proxy
5828
5829 See also : "option httpclose"
5830
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005831
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005832option independent-streams
5833no option independent-streams
5834 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02005835 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5836 yes | yes | yes | yes
5837 Arguments : none
5838
5839 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
5840 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
5841 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
5842 receive data or not.
5843
5844 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
5845 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
5846 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
5847 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
5848 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
5849 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
5850 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
5851 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
5852 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
5853 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
5854 socket buffers.
5855
5856 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
5857 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
5858 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
5859 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
5860 slow lines, so use it with caution.
5861
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005862 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independent-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005863 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
5864 deprecated.
5865
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02005866 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02005867
5868
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02005869option ldap-check
5870 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
5871 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5872 yes | no | yes | yes
5873 Arguments : none
5874
5875 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
5876 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
5877 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
5878 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
5879
5880 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
5881 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
5882
5883 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
5884 configure it.
5885
5886 Example :
5887 option ldap-check
5888
5889 See also : "option httpchk"
5890
5891
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005892option external-check
5893 Use external processes for server health checks
5894 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5895 yes | no | yes | yes
5896
5897 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
5898 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
5899 command".
5900
5901 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
5902
5903 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
5904
5905
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005906option log-health-checks
5907no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005908 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005909 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5910 yes | no | yes | yes
5911 Arguments : none
5912
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005913 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
5914 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
5915 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005916
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005917 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
5918 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
5919 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
5920 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
5921 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
5922
5923 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (eg: enable/disable on
5924 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005925
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02005926 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
5927 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
5928 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005929
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005930
5931option log-separate-errors
5932no option log-separate-errors
5933 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
5934 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5935 yes | yes | yes | no
5936 Arguments : none
5937
5938 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
5939 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
5940 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
5941 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
5942 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
5943 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
5944 provides very important information.
5945
5946 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
5947 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
5948 error logs.
5949
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005950 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005951 logging.
5952
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005953
5954option logasap
5955no option logasap
5956 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
5957 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5958 yes | yes | yes | no
5959 Arguments : none
5960
5961 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
5962 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
5963 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
5964 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
5965 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
5966 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
5967 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005968 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005969 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
5970 bytes are expected to be transferred.
5971
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005972 Examples :
5973 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
5974 mode http
5975 option httplog
5976 option logasap
5977 log 192.168.2.200 local3
5978
5979 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
5980 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
5981 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
5982 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
5983
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005984 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005985 logging.
5986
5987
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02005988option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02005989 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01005990 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5991 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02005992 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005993 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
5994 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02005995 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02005996
5997 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
5998 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
5999 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
6000 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
6001 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
6002 in the MySQL table, like this :
6003
6004 USE mysql;
6005 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
6006 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
6007
6008 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
6009 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
6010 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
6011 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
6012 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
6013 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
6014 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
6015 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
6016 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
6017
6018 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
6019 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006020
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02006021 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006022
6023 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
6024 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
6025 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6026 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006027 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
6028 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006029
6030 See also: "option httpchk"
6031
6032
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006033option nolinger
6034no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006035 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006036 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6037 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006038 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006039
6040 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
6041 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
6042 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
6043 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
6044 connections.
6045
6046 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
6047 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
6048 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
6049 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
6050 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
6051 this too.
6052
6053 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
6054 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
6055 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
6056
6057 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
6058 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
6059 for servers.
6060
6061 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6062 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6063
6064
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006065option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
6066 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
6067 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6068 yes | yes | yes | yes
6069 Arguments :
6070 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6071 matching <network>
6072 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
6073 header name.
6074
6075 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
6076 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
6077 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
6078 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
6079 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
6080 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
6081 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
6082 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
6083 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6084 possible that the client has already brought one.
6085
6086 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
6087 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
6088 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
6089 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
6090 header and requires different one.
6091
6092 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6093 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6094 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6095 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6096 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6097 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6098 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6099
6100 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
6101 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6102 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
6103 both are defined.
6104
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006105 Examples :
6106 # Original Destination address
6107 frontend www
6108 mode http
6109 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
6110
6111 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
6112 backend www
6113 mode http
6114 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
6115
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006116 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
6117 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006118
6119
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006120option persist
6121no option persist
6122 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
6123 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6124 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006125 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006126
6127 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
6128 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
6129 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
6130 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
6131 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
6132 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
6133 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
6134 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
6135 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
6136 redirected to another valid server.
6137
6138 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6139 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6140
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006141 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006142
6143
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01006144option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
6145 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
6146 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6147 yes | no | yes | yes
6148 Arguments :
6149 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
6150 PostgreSQL server.
6151
6152 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
6153 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
6154 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
6155 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
6156
6157 See also: "option httpchk"
6158
6159
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006160option prefer-last-server
6161no option prefer-last-server
6162 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
6163 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6164 yes | no | yes | yes
6165 Arguments : none
6166
6167 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
6168 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
6169 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
6170 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
6171 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
6172 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
6173 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
6174 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
6175 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01006176 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
6177 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
6178 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required). This is mandatory for
6179 use with the broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
6180 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
6181 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
6182 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006183
6184 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6185 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6186
6187 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
6188
6189
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006190option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006191option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006192no option redispatch
6193 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
6194 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6195 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006196 Arguments :
6197 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
6198 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
6199 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
6200 N indicate a redispath is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
6201 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
6202 historical behaviour of redispatching on the last retry, a
6203 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
6204 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
6205 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
6206
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006207
6208 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
6209 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
6210 be able to access the service anymore.
6211
6212 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
6213 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
6214
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006215 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006216 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
6217 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006218
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006219 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
6220 "redisp" keywords.
6221
6222 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6223 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6224
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006225 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006226
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006227
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02006228option redis-check
6229 Use redis health checks for server testing
6230 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6231 yes | no | yes | yes
6232 Arguments : none
6233
6234 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
6235 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
6236 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
6237 find the "+PONG" response message.
6238
6239 Example :
6240 option redis-check
6241
6242 See also : "option httpchk"
6243
6244
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006245option smtpchk
6246option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
6247 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
6248 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6249 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006250 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006251 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
6252 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
6253 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
6254
6255 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
6256 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
6257 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
6258
6259 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
6260 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
6261 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
6262 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
6263 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
6264 dead server.
6265
6266 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
6267 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
6268 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
6269 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
6270
6271 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
6272 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
6273 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6274 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006275 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006276
6277 Example :
6278 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
6279
6280 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
6281
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006282
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02006283option socket-stats
6284no option socket-stats
6285
6286 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
6287 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6288 yes | yes | yes | no
6289
6290 Arguments : none
6291
6292
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006293option splice-auto
6294no option splice-auto
6295 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
6296 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6297 yes | yes | yes | yes
6298 Arguments : none
6299
6300 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
6301 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
6302 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
6303 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006304 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006305 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
6306 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
6307 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
6308 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6309
6310 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
6311 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
6312 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
6313 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
6314 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
6315 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
6316 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
6317 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
6318 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
6319 keyword.
6320
6321 Example :
6322 option splice-auto
6323
6324 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6325 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6326
6327 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
6328 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6329
6330
6331option splice-request
6332no option splice-request
6333 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
6334 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6335 yes | yes | yes | yes
6336 Arguments : none
6337
6338 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006339 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006340 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
6341 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
6342 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
6343 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6344
6345 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
6346
6347 Example :
6348 option splice-request
6349
6350 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6351 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6352
6353 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
6354 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6355
6356
6357option splice-response
6358no option splice-response
6359 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
6360 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6361 yes | yes | yes | yes
6362 Arguments : none
6363
6364 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006365 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006366 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
6367 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
6368 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
6369 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6370
6371 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
6372
6373 Example :
6374 option splice-response
6375
6376 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6377 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6378
6379 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
6380 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6381
6382
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01006383option spop-check
6384 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
6385 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6386 no | no | no | yes
6387 Arguments : none
6388
6389 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
6390 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
6391 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
6392 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
6393
6394 Example :
6395 option spop-check
6396
6397 See also : "option httpchk"
6398
6399
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006400option srvtcpka
6401no option srvtcpka
6402 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
6403 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6404 yes | no | yes | yes
6405 Arguments : none
6406
6407 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6408 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
6409 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
6410 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6411
6412 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6413 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6414 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6415 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6416
6417 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6418 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6419 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6420 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6421 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6422
6423 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6424
6425 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
6426 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
6427 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
6428
6429 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6430 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6431
6432 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
6433
6434
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006435option ssl-hello-chk
6436 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
6437 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6438 yes | no | yes | yes
6439 Arguments : none
6440
6441 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
6442 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
6443 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
6444 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
6445 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
6446 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
6447 hello message.
6448
6449 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
6450 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
6451 messages, which is appreciable.
6452
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02006453 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
6454 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
6455 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006456
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02006457 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
6458
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006459
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006460option tcp-check
6461 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
6462 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6463 yes | no | yes | yes
6464
6465 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
6466 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
6467
6468 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
6469 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
6470 attempt, which remains the default mode.
6471
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006472 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006473 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
6474 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
6475 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
6476 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
6477 only.
6478
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006479 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006480 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
6481 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
6482 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
6483 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
6484
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006485 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006486 used to test a hello-type protocol. Haproxy sends a message, the server
6487 responds and its response is analysed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006488 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006489 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
6490 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
6491 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
6492 the respective protocols.
6493 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
6494 analysed.
6495
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006496 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
6497 script.
6498
6499 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
6500 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
6501 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
6502 The "comment" is of course optional.
6503
6504
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006505 Examples :
6506 # perform a POP check (analyse only server's banner)
6507 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006508 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006509
6510 # perform an IMAP check (analyse only server's banner)
6511 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006512 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006513
6514 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
6515 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006516 # (send a command then analyse the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006517 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006518 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006519 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02006520 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006521 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006522 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
6523 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006524 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006525 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
6526 tcp-check expect string +OK
6527
6528 forge a HTTP request, then analyse the response
6529 (send many headers before analyzing)
6530 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006531 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006532 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
6533 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
6534 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
6535 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006536 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006537
6538
6539 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
6540
6541
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02006542option tcp-smart-accept
6543no option tcp-smart-accept
6544 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
6545 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6546 yes | yes | yes | no
6547 Arguments : none
6548
6549 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
6550 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
6551 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
6552 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
6553 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
6554 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
6555
6556 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
6557 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
6558 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
6559 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
6560
6561 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
6562 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
6563 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
6564 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
6565
6566 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
6567 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
6568 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
6569
6570 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
6571 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
6572 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
6573
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02006574 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
6575
6576
6577option tcp-smart-connect
6578no option tcp-smart-connect
6579 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
6580 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6581 yes | no | yes | yes
6582 Arguments : none
6583
6584 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
6585 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
6586 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
6587 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
6588 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
6589
6590 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
6591 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
6592 complex.
6593
6594 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
6595 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
6596 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
6597
6598 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6599 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6600
6601 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
6602
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02006603
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006604option tcpka
6605 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
6606 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6607 yes | yes | yes | yes
6608 Arguments : none
6609
6610 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6611 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
6612 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
6613 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6614
6615 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6616 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6617 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6618 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6619
6620 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6621 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6622 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6623 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6624 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6625
6626 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6627
6628 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
6629 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
6630 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
6631 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
6632 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
6633 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
6634 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
6635 backends.
6636
6637 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
6638
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006639
6640option tcplog
6641 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
6642 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6643 yes | yes | yes | yes
6644 Arguments : none
6645
6646 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
6647 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
6648 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
6649 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
6650 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
6651 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
6652 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
6653 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
6654
6655 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
6656
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006657 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006658
6659
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006660option transparent
6661no option transparent
6662 Enable client-side transparent proxying
6663 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01006664 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006665 Arguments : none
6666
6667 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
6668 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
6669 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
6670 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
6671 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
6672 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
6673 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
6674 appropriate server.
6675
6676 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
6677 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
6678
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01006679 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006680 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006681
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006682
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006683external-check command <command>
6684 Executable to run when performing an external-check
6685 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6686 yes | no | yes | yes
6687
6688 Arguments :
6689 <command> is the external command to run
6690
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006691 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
6692
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01006693 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006694
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01006695 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
6696 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
6697 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
6698 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
6699 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
6700 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006701
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01006702 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
6703
6704 Environment variables :
6705 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
6706 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
6707
6708 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
6709
6710 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
6711
6712 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
6713 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
6714 for a UNIX socket).
6715
6716 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
6717
6718 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
6719
6720 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
6721
6722 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
6723
6724 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
6725
6726 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
6727 socket).
6728
6729 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
6730 the command may be set using "external-check path".
6731
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006732 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
6733 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
6734 failed.
6735
6736 Example :
6737 external-check command /bin/true
6738
6739 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
6740
6741
6742external-check path <path>
6743 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
6744 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6745 yes | no | yes | yes
6746
6747 Arguments :
6748 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
6749
6750 The default path is "".
6751
6752 Example :
6753 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
6754
6755 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
6756 "external-check command"
6757
6758
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006759persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02006760persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006761 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
6762 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6763 yes | no | yes | yes
6764 Arguments :
6765 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02006766 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
6767 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006768
6769 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
6770 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
6771 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
6772 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
6773 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
6774 forwarded to this server.
6775
6776 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
6777 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
6778 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006779 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006780 a single "listen" section.
6781
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02006782 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
6783 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
6784 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
6785
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006786 Example :
6787 listen tse-farm
6788 bind :3389
6789 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
6790 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
6791 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
6792 # apply RDP cookie persistence
6793 persist rdp-cookie
6794 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006795 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006796 balance rdp-cookie
6797 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
6798 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
6799
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09006800 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
6801 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006802
6803
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01006804rate-limit sessions <rate>
6805 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
6806 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6807 yes | yes | yes | no
6808 Arguments :
6809 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
6810 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
6811
6812 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
6813 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
6814 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
6815 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
6816 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
6817 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
6818
6819 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
6820 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
6821 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
6822 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
6823
6824 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
6825 listen smtp
6826 mode tcp
6827 bind :25
6828 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02006829 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01006830
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02006831 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
6832 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
6833 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01006834
6835 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
6836
6837
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006838redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6839redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6840redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006841 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
6842 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6843 no | yes | yes | yes
6844
6845 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01006846 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006847
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006848 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006849 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006850 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
6851 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
6852 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006853
6854 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
6855 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
6856 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
6857 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
6858 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006859 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
6860 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
6861 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
6862 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006863
6864 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
6865 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
6866 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
6867 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
6868 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
6869 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006870 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006871 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006872 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
6873 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
6874 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006875
6876 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01006877 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
6878 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
6879 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02006880 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01006881 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
6882 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
6883 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
6884 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006885
6886 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
6887 expected behaviour of a redirection :
6888
6889 - "drop-query"
6890 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
6891 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
6892 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
6893 with a location-type redirect.
6894
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01006895 - "append-slash"
6896 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
6897 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
6898 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
6899 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
6900
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006901 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
6902 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
6903 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
6904 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
6905 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
6906 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
6907 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
6908
6909 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
6910 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
6911 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
6912 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
6913 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
6914 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
6915 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006916
6917 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
6918 acl clear dst_port 80
6919 acl secure dst_port 8080
6920 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006921 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01006922 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006923 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
6924
6925 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01006926 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
6927 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
6928 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006929 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006930
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01006931 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
6932 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
6933 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
6934
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006935 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01006936 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006937
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006938 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02006939 http-request redirect code 301 location \
6940 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
6941 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006942
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006943 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006944
6945
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006946redisp (deprecated)
6947redispatch (deprecated)
6948 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
6949 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6950 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006951 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006952
6953 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
6954 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
6955 be able to access the service anymore.
6956
6957 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
6958 redistribute them to a working server.
6959
6960 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
6961 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
6962 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006963
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006964 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
6965 "option redispatch" instead.
6966
6967 See also : "option redispatch"
6968
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006969
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01006970reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006971 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
6972 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6973 no | yes | yes | yes
6974 Arguments :
6975 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
6976 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006977 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006978
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01006979 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
6980 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
6981
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006982 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
6983 the last header of an HTTP request.
6984
6985 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
6986 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
6987 responses.
6988
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01006989 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
6990 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
6991 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
6992
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006993 See also: "rspadd", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation,
6994 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006995
6996
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01006997reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
6998reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01006999 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
7000 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7001 no | yes | yes | yes
7002 Arguments :
7003 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7004 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7005 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7006 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7007 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7008 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
7009 ignores case.
7010
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007011 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7012 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7013
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007014 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7015 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
7016 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
7017 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007018 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007019
7020 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7021 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7022
7023 Example :
7024 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
7025 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7026 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7027
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007028 See also: "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header
7029 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007030
7031
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007032reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7033reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007034 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
7035 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7036 no | yes | yes | yes
7037 Arguments :
7038 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7039 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7040 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7041 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7042 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
7043 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
7044
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007045 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7046 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7047
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007048 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
7049 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
7050 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
7051 next servers.
7052
7053 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7054 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7055 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
7056
7057 Example :
7058 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
7059 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
7060 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
7061
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007062 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", "http-request", section 6 about
7063 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007064
7065
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007066reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7067reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007068 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
7069 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7070 no | yes | yes | yes
7071 Arguments :
7072 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7073 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7074 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7075 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7076 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7077 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
7078 case.
7079
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007080 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7081 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7082
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007083 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7084 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
7085 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
7086 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007087 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007088
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007089 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007090 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007091 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007092
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007093 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7094 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7095
7096 Example :
7097 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
7098 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7099 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7100
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007101 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
7102 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007103
7104
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007105reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7106reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007107 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
7108 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7109 no | yes | yes | yes
7110 Arguments :
7111 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7112 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7113 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7114 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7115 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7116 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
7117 case.
7118
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007119 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7120 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7121
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007122 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7123 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
7124 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
7125 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
7126
7127 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7128 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7129
7130 Example :
7131 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
7132 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
7133 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7134 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7135
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007136 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
7137 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007138
7139
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007140reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7141reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007142 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
7143 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7144 no | yes | yes | yes
7145 Arguments :
7146 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7147 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7148 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7149 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7150 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
7151 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
7152
7153 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7154 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
7155 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
7156 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007157 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007158
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007159 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7160 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7161
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007162 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
7163 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
7164 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
7165
7166 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7167 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7168 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
7169 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
7170 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
7171
7172 Example :
7173 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007174 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007175 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
7176 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
7177
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007178 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", "http-request",
7179 section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007180
7181
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007182reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7183reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007184 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
7185 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7186 no | yes | yes | yes
7187 Arguments :
7188 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7189 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7190 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7191 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7192 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7193 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
7194 ignores case.
7195
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007196 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7197 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7198
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007199 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7200 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007201 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
7202 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
7203 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007204 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
7205 not set.
7206
7207 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
7208 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
7209 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
7210 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
7211 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
7212
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007213 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007214 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
7215 # block all others.
7216 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
7217 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
7218
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007219 # block bad guys
7220 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
7221 reqitarpit . if badguys
7222
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007223 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", "http-request", section 6
7224 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007225
7226
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007227retries <value>
7228 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
7229 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7230 yes | no | yes | yes
7231 Arguments :
7232 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
7233 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
7234 default value is 3.
7235
7236 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
7237 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
7238 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
7239
7240 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007241 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
7242 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007243
7244 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
7245 server even if a cookie references a different server.
7246
7247 See also : "option redispatch"
7248
7249
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007250rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007251 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
7252 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7253 no | yes | yes | yes
7254 Arguments :
7255 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7256 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007257 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007258
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007259 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7260 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7261
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007262 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
7263 the last header of an HTTP response.
7264
7265 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7266 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7267 responses.
7268
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007269 See also: "rspdel" "reqadd", "http-response", section 6 about HTTP header
7270 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007271
7272
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007273rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7274rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007275 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
7276 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7277 no | yes | yes | yes
7278 Arguments :
7279 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7280 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7281 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7282 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7283 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7284 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
7285 ignores case.
7286
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007287 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7288 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7289
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007290 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
7291 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007292 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007293 client.
7294
7295 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7296 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7297 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
7298
7299 Example :
7300 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02007301 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007302
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007303 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", "http-response", section 6 about
7304 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007305
7306
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007307rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7308rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007309 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
7310 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7311 no | yes | yes | yes
7312 Arguments :
7313 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7314 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7315 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7316 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7317 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7318 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
7319 ignores case.
7320
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007321 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7322 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7323
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007324 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7325 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
7326 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
7327 case-sensitive.
7328
7329 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007330 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
7331 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
7332 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007333
7334 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7335 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
7336
7337 Example :
7338 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
7339 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
7340
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007341 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", "http-response", section 6 about
7342 HTTP header manipulation and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007343
7344
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007345rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7346rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007347 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
7348 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7349 no | yes | yes | yes
7350 Arguments :
7351 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7352 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7353 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7354 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7355 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7356 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
7357 ignores case.
7358
7359 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7360 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
7361 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
7362 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007363 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007364
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007365 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7366 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7367
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007368 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
7369 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
7370 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
7371
7372 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7373 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7374 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
7375 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
7376 are not case-sensitive.
7377
7378 Example :
7379 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
7380 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
7381
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007382 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", "http-response", section 6 about
7383 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007384
7385
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007386server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007387 Declare a server in a backend
7388 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7389 no | no | yes | yes
7390 Arguments :
7391 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02007392 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007393 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007394
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007395 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
7396 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
7397 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
7398 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02007399 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
7400 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
7401 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
7402 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
7403 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007404 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
7405 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
7406 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
7407 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
7408 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
7409 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
7410 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02007411 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007412 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7413 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01007414 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
7415 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007416
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007417 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007418 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
7419 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
7420 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
7421 adding this value to the client's port.
7422
7423 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
7424 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007425 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007426
7427 Examples :
7428 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
7429 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007430 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007431 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
7432 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
7433 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007434
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02007435 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
7436 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
7437 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
7438 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
7439 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
7440
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007441 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
7442 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007443
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007444server-state-file-name [<file>]
7445 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
7446 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
7447 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
7448 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
7449 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
7450 global directive "server-state-file-base".
7451
7452 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
7453 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
7454
7455 global
7456 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
7457
7458 backend bk
7459 load-server-state-from-file
7460
7461 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
7462 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007463
7464source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007465source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01007466source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007467 Set the source address for outgoing connections
7468 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7469 yes | no | yes | yes
7470 Arguments :
7471 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
7472 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007473
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007474 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007475 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
7476 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
7477 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
7478 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
7479 supported prefixes are :
7480 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
7481 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
7482 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02007483 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02007484 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7485 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007486
7487 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
7488 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007489 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
7490 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
7491 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007492
7493 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
7494 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
7495 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
7496 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
7497 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
7498 <addr>.
7499
7500 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
7501 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
7502 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
7503 port.
7504
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007505 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
7506 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
7507 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
7508 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01007509 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007510 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
7511 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
7512 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
7513 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
7514 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
7515 HTTP header.
7516
7517 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
7518 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007519 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007520 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
7521 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
7522 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
7523 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
7524 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
7525 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
7526 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
7527
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01007528 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
7529 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
7530 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
7531 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
7532 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
7533 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
7534
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007535 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
7536 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
7537 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
7538 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
7539
7540 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
7541 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
7542 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
7543 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
7544 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
7545 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
7546
7547 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
7548 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
7549 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
7550 there are two methods :
7551
7552 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
7553 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
7554 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
7555 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
7556 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
7557 of the client ranges may be used.
7558
7559 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
7560 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
7561 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
7562 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
7563 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
7564 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
7565 same session.
7566
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007567 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
7568 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
7569 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007570 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007571
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02007572 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
7573
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007574 Examples :
7575 backend private
7576 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
7577 source 192.168.1.200
7578
7579 backend transparent_ssl1
7580 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
7581 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
7582
7583 backend transparent_ssl2
7584 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
7585 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
7586 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
7587
7588 backend transparent_ssl3
7589 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
7590 # is more conntrack-friendly.
7591 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
7592
7593 backend transparent_smtp
7594 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
7595 # with Tproxy version 4.
7596 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
7597
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007598 backend transparent_http
7599 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
7600 # proxy.
7601 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
7602
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007603 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007604 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
7605
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007606
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007607srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7608 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
7609 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7610 yes | no | yes | yes
7611 Arguments :
7612 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7613 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7614 as explained at the top of this document.
7615
7616 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
7617 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7618 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
7619 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
7620 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
7621 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
7622 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
7623
7624 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7625 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7626 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
7627 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
7628 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007629 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007630 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007631 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007632
7633 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7634 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7635 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7636 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7637 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7638 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7639
7640 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
7641 Please use "timeout server" instead.
7642
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007643 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
7644 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007645
7646
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007647stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
7648 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
7649 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007650 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007651
7652 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
7653 matched.
7654
7655 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
7656 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
7657
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007658 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7659 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7660 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7661
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01007662 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
7663 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
7664 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
7665 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007666
7667 Example :
7668 # statistics admin level only for localhost
7669 backend stats_localhost
7670 stats enable
7671 stats admin if LOCALHOST
7672
7673 Example :
7674 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
7675 backend stats_auth
7676 stats enable
7677 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
7678 stats admin if TRUE
7679
7680 Example :
7681 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
7682 userlist stats-auth
7683 group admin users admin
7684 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
7685 group readonly users haproxy
7686 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
7687
7688 backend stats_auth
7689 stats enable
7690 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
7691 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
7692 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
7693 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
7694
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007695 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
7696 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
7697 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007698
7699
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007700stats auth <user>:<passwd>
7701 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
7702 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007703 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007704 Arguments :
7705 <user> is a user name to grant access to
7706
7707 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
7708
7709 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
7710 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
7711 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
7712 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
7713 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
7714 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
7715
7716 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
7717 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
7718 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007719 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007720
7721 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
7722 report using "stats scope".
7723
7724 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7725 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7726 unobvious parameters.
7727
7728 Example :
7729 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7730 backend public_www
7731 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7732 stats enable
7733 stats hide-version
7734 stats scope .
7735 stats uri /admin?stats
7736 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7737 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7738 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7739
7740 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7741 backend private_monitoring
7742 stats enable
7743 stats uri /admin?stats
7744 stats refresh 5s
7745
7746 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
7747
7748
7749stats enable
7750 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
7751 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007752 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007753 Arguments : none
7754
7755 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
7756 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
7757 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
7758 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
7759 - stats auth : no authentication
7760 - stats scope : no restriction
7761
7762 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7763 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7764 unobvious parameters.
7765
7766 Example :
7767 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7768 backend public_www
7769 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7770 stats enable
7771 stats hide-version
7772 stats scope .
7773 stats uri /admin?stats
7774 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7775 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7776 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7777
7778 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7779 backend private_monitoring
7780 stats enable
7781 stats uri /admin?stats
7782 stats refresh 5s
7783
7784 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
7785
7786
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007787stats hide-version
7788 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007789 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007790 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007791 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007792
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007793 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
7794 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
7795 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
7796 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
7797 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
7798 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007799
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02007800 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7801 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7802 unobvious parameters.
7803
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007804 Example :
7805 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7806 backend public_www
7807 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02007808 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007809 stats hide-version
7810 stats scope .
7811 stats uri /admin?stats
7812 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7813 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7814 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007815
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007816 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7817 backend private_monitoring
7818 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007819 stats uri /admin?stats
7820 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01007821
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007822 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007823
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01007824
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02007825stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
7826 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7827 Access control for statistics
7828
7829 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7830 no | no | yes | yes
7831
7832 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
7833 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
7834 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
7835 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
7836 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
7837 should be asked to enter a username and password.
7838
7839 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
7840 instance.
7841
7842 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
7843 about ACL usage.
7844
7845
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007846stats realm <realm>
7847 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
7848 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007849 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007850 Arguments :
7851 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
7852 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
7853 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
7854
7855 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
7856 using a backslash ('\').
7857
7858 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
7859 only related to authentication.
7860
7861 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7862 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7863 unobvious parameters.
7864
7865 Example :
7866 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7867 backend public_www
7868 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7869 stats enable
7870 stats hide-version
7871 stats scope .
7872 stats uri /admin?stats
7873 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7874 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7875 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7876
7877 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7878 backend private_monitoring
7879 stats enable
7880 stats uri /admin?stats
7881 stats refresh 5s
7882
7883 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
7884
7885
7886stats refresh <delay>
7887 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
7888 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007889 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007890 Arguments :
7891 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
7892 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
7893 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
7894 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
7895 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
7896 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
7897
7898 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
7899 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
7900 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
7901 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
7902
7903 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7904 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7905 unobvious parameters.
7906
7907 Example :
7908 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7909 backend public_www
7910 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7911 stats enable
7912 stats hide-version
7913 stats scope .
7914 stats uri /admin?stats
7915 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7916 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7917 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7918
7919 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7920 backend private_monitoring
7921 stats enable
7922 stats uri /admin?stats
7923 stats refresh 5s
7924
7925 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
7926
7927
7928stats scope { <name> | "." }
7929 Enable statistics and limit access scope
7930 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007931 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007932 Arguments :
7933 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
7934 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
7935 section in which the statement appears.
7936
7937 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
7938 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
7939 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
7940 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
7941 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
7942 exists.
7943
7944 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7945 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7946 unobvious parameters.
7947
7948 Example :
7949 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7950 backend public_www
7951 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7952 stats enable
7953 stats hide-version
7954 stats scope .
7955 stats uri /admin?stats
7956 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7957 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7958 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7959
7960 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7961 backend private_monitoring
7962 stats enable
7963 stats uri /admin?stats
7964 stats refresh 5s
7965
7966 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
7967
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007968
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007969stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007970 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
7971 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007972 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007973
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02007974 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007975 description from global section is automatically used instead.
7976
7977 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
7978 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
7979
7980 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7981 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007982 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007983
7984 Example :
7985 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7986 backend private_monitoring
7987 stats enable
7988 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
7989 stats uri /admin?stats
7990 stats refresh 5s
7991
7992 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
7993 global section.
7994
7995
7996stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007997 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
7998 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7999 yes | yes | yes | yes
8000 Arguments : none
8001
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008002 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008003 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
8004 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
8005 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
8006 - IP (socket, server)
8007 - cookie (backend, server)
8008
8009 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8010 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04008011 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008012
8013 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
8014
8015
8016stats show-node [ <name> ]
8017 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
8018 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008019 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008020 Arguments:
8021 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
8022 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
8023
8024 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8025 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04008026 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008027
8028 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8029 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8030 unobvious parameters.
8031
8032 Example:
8033 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8034 backend private_monitoring
8035 stats enable
8036 stats show-node Europe-1
8037 stats uri /admin?stats
8038 stats refresh 5s
8039
8040 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
8041 section.
8042
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008043
8044stats uri <prefix>
8045 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
8046 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008047 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008048 Arguments :
8049 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
8050 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
8051 query string.
8052
8053 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
8054 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
8055 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
8056 possible to reach it in the application.
8057
8058 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008059 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008060 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
8061 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
8062 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
8063 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
8064
8065 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
8066 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
8067 an address or a port to statistics only.
8068
8069 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8070 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8071 unobvious parameters.
8072
8073 Example :
8074 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8075 backend public_www
8076 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8077 stats enable
8078 stats hide-version
8079 stats scope .
8080 stats uri /admin?stats
8081 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
8082 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8083 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8084
8085 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8086 backend private_monitoring
8087 stats enable
8088 stats uri /admin?stats
8089 stats refresh 5s
8090
8091 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
8092
8093
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008094stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
8095 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008096 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008097 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008098
8099 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008100 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008101 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
8102 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
8103 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
8104
8105 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8106 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8107 the "stick-table" statement.
8108
8109 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
8110 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
8111 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
8112 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
8113 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
8114
8115 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8116 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
8117 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
8118 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
8119 transformation rules.
8120
8121 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8122 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8123 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8124 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8125 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8126 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8127 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8128
8129 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
8130 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
8131 ACL based conditions.
8132
8133 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
8134 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
8135 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
8136 matches can be used as fallbacks.
8137
8138 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
8139 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
8140 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
8141 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
8142
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008143 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8144 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
8145 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
8146
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008147 Example :
8148 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8149 # last 30 minutes
8150 backend pop
8151 mode tcp
8152 balance roundrobin
8153 stick store-request src
8154 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8155 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8156 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8157
8158 backend smtp
8159 mode tcp
8160 balance roundrobin
8161 stick match src table pop
8162 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8163 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8164
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008165 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008166 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008167
8168
8169stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8170 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
8171 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8172 no | no | yes | yes
8173
8174 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
8175 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
8176 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
8177 for writing more maintainable configurations.
8178
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008179 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8180 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
8181 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
8182
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008183 Examples :
8184 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01008185 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008186
8187 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
8188 stick match src table pop if !localhost
8189 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
8190
8191
8192 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
8193 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
8194 backend http
8195 mode http
8196 balance roundrobin
8197 stick on src table https
8198 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
8199 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
8200 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
8201
8202 backend https
8203 mode tcp
8204 balance roundrobin
8205 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8206 stick on src
8207 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
8208 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
8209
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008210 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008211
8212
8213stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8214 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
8215 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8216 no | no | yes | yes
8217
8218 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008219 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008220 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
8221 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
8222 server is selected.
8223
8224 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8225 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8226 the "stick-table" statement.
8227
8228 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8229 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8230 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
8231 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
8232 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
8233 address.
8234
8235 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8236 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
8237 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
8238 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
8239 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
8240 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
8241 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
8242 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
8243 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
8244 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
8245
8246 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8247 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8248 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8249 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8250 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8251 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8252 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8253
8254 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
8255 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8256 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
8257 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8258
8259 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
8260 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8261 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8262 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
8263 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
8264 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01008265 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
8266 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
8267 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
8268 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
8269 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
8270 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008271
8272 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
8273 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
8274 the request.
8275
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008276 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8277 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
8278 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
8279
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008280 Example :
8281 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8282 # last 30 minutes
8283 backend pop
8284 mode tcp
8285 balance roundrobin
8286 stick store-request src
8287 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8288 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8289 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8290
8291 backend smtp
8292 mode tcp
8293 balance roundrobin
8294 stick match src table pop
8295 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8296 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8297
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008298 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008299 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008300
8301
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008302stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008303 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
8304 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08008305 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008306 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008307 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008308
8309 Arguments :
8310 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
8311 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
8312 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8313 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8314
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01008315 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
8316 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
8317 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8318 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8319
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008320 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
8321 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
8322 instance.
8323
8324 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
8325 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
8326 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
8327 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
8328 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
8329 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008330 to 32 characters.
8331
8332 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
8333 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
8334 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008335 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008336 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
8337 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008338
8339 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008340 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
8341 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008342 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
8343 increase.
8344
8345 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008346 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
8347 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
8348 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008349
8350 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
8351 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
8352 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
8353 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
8354 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
8355 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
8356 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
8357 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
8358 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
8359 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
8360 parameter (see below).
8361
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008362 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
8363 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
8364 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
8365 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
8366 soft restart.
8367
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02008368 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
8369 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008370
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008371 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
8372 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
8373 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
8374 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
8375 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008376 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008377 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
8378 if not expiration delay is specified.
8379
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02008380 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
8381 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
8382 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
8383 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008384 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
8385 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
8386 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
8387 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
8388 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
8389 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
8390 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
8391 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
8392 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
8393 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
8394 types and their arguments.
8395
8396 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
8397 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
8398 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
8399 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
8400
8401 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
8402 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
8403 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
8404 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
8405
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02008406 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
8407 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
8408 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
8409 a cumulative count, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
8410 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
8411 occurrence of certain events (eg: requests to a specific URL).
8412
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008413 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
8414 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
8415 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
8416 they were received.
8417
8418 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8419 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
8420 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
8421 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
8422 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
8423
8424 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8425 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8426 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8427 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
8428 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8429
8430 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
8431 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
8432 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
8433
8434 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8435 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8436 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8437 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
8438 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8439
8440 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8441 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
8442 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
8443 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
8444 the client side.
8445
8446 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8447 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8448 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8449 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
8450 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
8451 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
8452 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
8453
8454 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8455 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
8456 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
8457 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
8458 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
8459 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
8460 (eg: vulnerability scan).
8461
8462 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8463 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8464 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8465 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
8466 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
8467 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8468
8469 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
8470 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
8471 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
8472 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
8473
8474 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8475 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8476 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8477 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
8478 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
8479 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
8480 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
8481 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
8482 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
8483 recommended for better fairness.
8484
8485 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
8486 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
8487 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
8488 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
8489
8490 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
8491 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8492 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8493 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
8494 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
8495 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
8496 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
8497 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
8498 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
8499 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02008500
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008501 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
8502 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008503 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
8504 reference it.
8505
8506 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
8507 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +01008508 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
8509 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
8510 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008511
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008512 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
8513 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
8514 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
8515 something that can be ignored.
8516
8517 Example:
8518 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
8519 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
8520 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
8521 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
8522
8523 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01008524 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008525
8526
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008527stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +01008528 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008529 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8530 no | no | yes | yes
8531
8532 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008533 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008534 describes what elements of the response or connection will
8535 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
8536 server is selected.
8537
8538 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8539 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8540 the "stick-table" statement.
8541
8542 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8543 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8544 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
8545 when the response is a SSL server hello.
8546
8547 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8548 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
8549 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
8550 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
8551 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
8552 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008553 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008554 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
8555 rules.
8556
8557 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8558 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8559 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8560 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8561 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8562 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8563 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8564
8565 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
8566 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8567 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
8568 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8569
8570 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
8571 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8572 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8573 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
8574 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
8575 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01008576 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
8577 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
8578 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
8579 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
8580 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
8581 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
8582 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
8583 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
8584 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008585
8586 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
8587
8588 Example :
8589 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
8590 backend https
8591 mode tcp
8592 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008593 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008594 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008595
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008596 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
8597 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
8598
8599 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
8600 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
8601 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
8602
8603 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
8604 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008605
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008606 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
8607 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
8608 # at offset 44.
8609
8610 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
8611 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
8612
8613 # Learn on response if server hello.
8614 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008615
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008616 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
8617 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
8618
8619 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
8620 extraction.
8621
8622
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02008623tcp-check connect [params*]
8624 Opens a new connection
8625 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8626 no | no | yes | yes
8627
8628 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
8629 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
8630 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
8631
8632 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
8633 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
8634 of the sequence.
8635
8636 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
8637 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
8638 do.
8639
8640 Parameters :
8641 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
8642 use the TCP connection.
8643
8644 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
8645 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
8646 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
8647
8648 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
8649
8650 ssl opens a ciphered connection
8651
8652 Examples:
8653 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
8654 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
8655 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
8656 option tcp-check
8657 tcp-check connect
8658 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
8659 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
8660 tcp-check send \r\n
8661 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
8662 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
8663 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
8664 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
8665 tcp-check send \r\n
8666 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
8667 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
8668
8669 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
8670 option tcp-check
8671 tcp-check connect port 110
8672 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
8673 tcp-check connect port 143
8674 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
8675 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
8676
8677 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
8678
8679
8680tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
8681 Specify data to be collected and analysed during a generic health check
8682 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8683 no | no | yes | yes
8684
8685 Arguments :
8686 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
8687 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
8688 binary.
8689 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
8690 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
8691 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
8692
8693 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
8694 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
8695 with the usual backslash ('\').
8696 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
8697 a serie of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
8698 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
8699 used upper or lower case.
8700
8701
8702 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
8703
8704 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
8705 A health check response will be considered valid if the
8706 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
8707 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
8708 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
8709 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
8710 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
8711 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
8712
8713 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
8714 A health check response will be considered valid if the
8715 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
8716 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
8717 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
8718 expression.
8719
8720 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
8721 in the response buffer. A health check response will
8722 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
8723 this exact hexadecimal string.
8724 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
8725
8726 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
8727 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
8728 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
8729 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
8730 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
8731 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
8732 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
8733 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
8734 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
8735 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
8736 the null character.
8737
8738 Examples :
8739 # perform a POP check
8740 option tcp-check
8741 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
8742
8743 # perform an IMAP check
8744 option tcp-check
8745 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
8746
8747 # look for the redis master server
8748 option tcp-check
8749 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02008750 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02008751 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
8752 tcp-check expect string role:master
8753 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
8754 tcp-check expect string +OK
8755
8756
8757 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
8758 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
8759
8760
8761tcp-check send <data>
8762 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8763 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8764 no | no | yes | yes
8765
8766 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8767 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
8768
8769 Examples :
8770 # look for the redis master server
8771 option tcp-check
8772 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
8773 tcp-check expect string role:master
8774
8775 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
8776 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
8777
8778
8779tcp-check send-binary <hexastring>
8780 Specify an hexa digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
8781 tcp health check
8782 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8783 no | no | yes | yes
8784
8785 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8786 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
8787 <hexastring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
8788 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
8789 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
8790 hexadecimal string.
8791 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
8792
8793 Examples :
8794 # redis check in binary
8795 option tcp-check
8796 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
8797 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
8798
8799
8800 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
8801 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
8802
8803
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008804tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8805 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02008806 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8807 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008808 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02008809 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
8810 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02008811
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008812 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008813
8814 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
8815 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008816 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
8817 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
8818 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
8819 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
8820 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
8821 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008822
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008823 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
8824 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
8825 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
8826 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008827
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02008828 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008829 - accept :
8830 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8831 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
8832 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008833
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008834 - reject :
8835 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8836 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
8837 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
8838 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
8839 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
8840 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
8841 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
8842 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
8843 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
8844 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
8845 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02008846 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008847
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02008848 - expect-proxy layer4 :
8849 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
8850 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
8851 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
8852 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
8853 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
8854 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
8855 hosts.
8856
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +01008857 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
8858 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
8859 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
8860 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
8861 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
8862 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
8863 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
8864 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
8865
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02008866 - capture <sample> len <length> :
8867 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
8868 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
8869 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
8870 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
8871 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
8872 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
8873 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
8874 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02008875 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
8876 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02008877
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008878 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008879 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02008880 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. 3 sets
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008881 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008882 first "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
8883 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008884 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02008885 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
8886 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
8887 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
8888 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
8889 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008890
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008891 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008892 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02008893 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008894 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
8895 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
8896 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
8897 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008898
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008899 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
8900 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
8901 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
8902 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008903
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008904 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
8905 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
8906 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
8907 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
8908 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01008909 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
8910 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
8911 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
8912 layer7 information is extracted.
8913
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008914 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
8915 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
8916 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
8917 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
8918 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008919
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02008920 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
8921 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
8922 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
8923 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
8924
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02008925 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>:
8926 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
8927 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
8928 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
8929 continues.
8930
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02008931 - set-src <expr> :
8932 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
8933 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
8934 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
8935 set-src"
8936
8937 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
8938 followed by some converters.
8939
8940 Example:
8941
8942 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
8943
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02008944 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
8945 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02008946
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02008947 - set-src-port <expr> :
8948 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
8949 expression.
8950
8951 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
8952 followed by some converters.
8953
8954 Example:
8955
8956 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
8957
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02008958 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
8959 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
8960 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02008961
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02008962 - set-dst <expr> :
8963 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
8964 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
8965 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
8966 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
8967 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
8968
8969 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
8970 followed by some converters.
8971
8972 Example:
8973
8974 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
8975 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
8976
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02008977 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
8978 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
8979
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02008980 - set-dst-port <expr> :
8981 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
8982 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
8983 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
8984
8985
8986 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
8987 followed by some converters.
8988
8989 Example:
8990
8991 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
8992
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02008993 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
8994 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
8995 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
8996
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02008997 - "silent-drop" :
8998 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
8999 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way that tries
9000 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9001 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9002 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9003 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9004 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
9005 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact
9006 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the
9007 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9008 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
9009 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
9010 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9011 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9012 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9013 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9014
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009015 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9016 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9017 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009018
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009019 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
9020 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
9021 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009022
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009023 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009024 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009025 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009026
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009027 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
9028 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
9029 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009030
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009031 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009032 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9033 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009034
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009035 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
9036
9037 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
9038
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009039 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9040
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009041 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009042
9043
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009044tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9045 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009046 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009047 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009048 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009049 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9050 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009051
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009052 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009053
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009054 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
9055 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9056 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
9057 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
9058 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009059
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009060 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
9061 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
9062 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
9063 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009064 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
9065 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
9066 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
9067 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
9068 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
9069 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009070 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009071 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009072
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009073 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9074 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9075 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9076 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009077
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009078 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009079 - accept : the request is accepted
9080 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
9081 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009082 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009083 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Thierry Fournierb9125672016-03-29 19:34:37 +02009084 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009085 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009086 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009087 - silent-drop
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009088
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009089 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
9090 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009091
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009092 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
9093 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
9094 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
9095 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
9096 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
9097 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009098
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009099 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009100 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9101 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009102
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009103 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009104 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
9105 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
9106 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
9107 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009108 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
9109 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
9110 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009111
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009112 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009113 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
9114 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
9115 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009116
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009117 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009118 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
9119 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009120
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009121 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9122 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01009123 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009124 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9125 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009126 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009127 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009128 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009129 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9130 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009131 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01009132 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
9133 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009134
9135 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9136 followed by some converters.
9137
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009138 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
9139 <var-name>.
9140
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009141 Example:
9142
9143 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009144 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009145
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009146 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009147 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
9148 # and reject everything else.
9149 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
9150 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009151 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009152 tcp-request content reject
9153
9154 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009155 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
9156 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9157 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009158 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009159
9160 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
9161 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9162 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009163 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009164 tcp-request content reject
9165
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009166 Example:
9167 # Track the last IP from X-Forwarded-For
9168 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009169 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009170
9171 Example:
9172 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
9173 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009174 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009175
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009176 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
9177 frontend when the backend detects abuse.
9178
9179 frontend http
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009180 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009181 # protecting all our sites
9182 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009183 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9184 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009185 ...
9186 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
9187
9188 backend http_dynamic
9189 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009190 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009191 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009192 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
9193 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
9194 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009195 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009196
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009197 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009198
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009199 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session", and
9200 "tcp-request inspect-delay"
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009201
9202
9203tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
9204 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
9205 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009206 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009207 Arguments :
9208 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9209 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9210 as explained at the top of this document.
9211
9212 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
9213 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
9214 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
9215 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
9216 data for at most the specified amount of time.
9217
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009218 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
9219 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
9220 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
9221 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
9222
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009223 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
9224 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009225 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009226 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01009227 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
9228 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
9229 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
9230 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009231
9232 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
9233 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
9234 it pass through unaffected.
9235
9236 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
9237 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
9238 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009239 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009240 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
9241 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02009242 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
9243 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
9244 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009245
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009246 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009247 "timeout client".
9248
9249
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009250tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9251 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
9252 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9253 no | no | yes | yes
9254 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009255 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9256 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009257
9258 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
9259
9260 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
9261 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9262 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009263 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
9264 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009265
9266 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
9267
9268 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9269 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9270 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9271 inserted.
9272
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009273 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009274 - accept :
9275 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9276 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9277 the rules evaluation.
9278
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009279 - close :
9280 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
9281 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
9282 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
9283 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
9284 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
9285 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009286 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009287 protocols.
9288
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009289 - reject :
9290 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9291 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009292 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009293
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009294 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
9295 Sets a variable.
9296
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009297 - unset-var(<var-name>)
9298 Unsets a variable.
9299
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009300 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9301 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9302 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
9303 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
9304
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009305 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
9306 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
9307 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
9308 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
9309 continues.
9310
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009311 - "silent-drop" :
9312 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
9313 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way that tries
9314 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9315 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9316 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9317 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9318 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
9319 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact
9320 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the
9321 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9322 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
9323 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
9324 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9325 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9326 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9327 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9328
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009329 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9330 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9331 for changing the default action to a reject.
9332
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009333 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
9334 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
9335 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
9336 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009337 period.
9338
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009339 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
9340 declared inline.
9341
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009342 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9343 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01009344 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009345 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9346 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009347 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009348 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009349 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009350 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9351 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009352 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01009353 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
9354 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009355
9356 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9357 followed by some converters.
9358
9359 Example:
9360
9361 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
9362
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009363 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
9364 <var-name>.
9365
9366 Example:
9367
9368 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
9369
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009370 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9371
9372 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
9373
9374
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009375tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9376 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
9377 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9378 no | yes | yes | no
9379 Arguments :
9380 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9381 below.
9382
9383 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
9384
9385 Once a session is validated, (ie. after all handshakes have been completed),
9386 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
9387 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
9388 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
9389 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
9390 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
9391 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
9392 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
9393 from the PROXY protocol header (eg: track a source forwarded this way). The
9394 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
9395 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
9396 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
9397 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
9398 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
9399 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
9400 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
9401 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
9402 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
9403 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
9404 instead.
9405
9406 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
9407 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
9408 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
9409 rules which may be inserted.
9410
9411 Several types of actions are supported :
9412 - accept : the request is accepted
9413 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
9414 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
9415 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
9416 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
9417 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009418 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009419 - silent-drop
9420
9421 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
9422 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
9423 sections for a complete description.
9424
9425 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9426 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9427 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
9428
9429 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
9430 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
9431 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
9432 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
9433 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
9434
9435 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
9436 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
9437
9438 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
9439 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
9440 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
9441
9442 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
9443 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
9444 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
9445
9446 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
9447 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
9448 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
9449
9450 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
9451 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
9452 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
9453
9454 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9455
9456 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
9457
9458
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009459tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
9460 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
9461 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9462 no | no | yes | yes
9463 Arguments :
9464 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9465 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9466 as explained at the top of this document.
9467
9468 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
9469
9470
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009471timeout check <timeout>
9472 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
9473 established.
9474
9475 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9476 yes | no | yes | yes
9477 Arguments:
9478 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9479 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9480 as explained at the top of this document.
9481
9482 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
9483 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
9484 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
9485 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01009486 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
9487 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
9488 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009489
9490 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
9491 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
9492
9493 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
9494 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009495 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009496
9497 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9498 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9499 forget about it.
9500
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009501 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
9502 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009503
9504
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009505timeout client <timeout>
9506timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9507 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
9508 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9509 yes | yes | yes | no
9510 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009511 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009512 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9513 as explained at the top of this document.
9514
9515 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
9516 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
9517 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +01009518 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
9519 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
9520 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
9521 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009522 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
9523 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
9524 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009525 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009526 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009527 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
9528 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009529 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
9530 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009531
9532 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
9533 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9534 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9535 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
9536 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
9537 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9538
9539 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
9540 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
9541 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
9542
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +01009543 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel",
9544 "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009545
9546
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009547timeout client-fin <timeout>
9548 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
9549 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9550 yes | yes | yes | no
9551 Arguments :
9552 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9553 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9554 as explained at the top of this document.
9555
9556 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
9557 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
9558 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
9559 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
9560 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
9561 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
9562 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
9563 down in one direction.
9564
9565 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
9566 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
9567 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
9568
9569 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
9570
9571
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009572timeout connect <timeout>
9573timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9574 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
9575 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9576 yes | no | yes | yes
9577 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009578 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009579 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9580 as explained at the top of this document.
9581
9582 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009583 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009584 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009585 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009586 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
9587 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009588
9589 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9590 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9591 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9592 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
9593 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
9594 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9595
9596 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
9597 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
9598 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
9599
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009600 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
9601 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009602
9603
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009604timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
9605 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
9606 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9607 yes | yes | yes | yes
9608 Arguments :
9609 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9610 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9611 as explained at the top of this document.
9612
9613 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
9614 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
9615 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
9616 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
9617 once the request has started to present itself.
9618
9619 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
9620 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
9621 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
9622 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
9623 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
9624
9625 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
9626 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
9627 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
9628 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
9629
9630 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
9631 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
9632 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
9633 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
9634 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02009635 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009636
9637 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
9638 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
9639 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
9640 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
9641
9642 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
9643
9644
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009645timeout http-request <timeout>
9646 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
9647 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02009648 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009649 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009650 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009651 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9652 as explained at the top of this document.
9653
9654 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
9655 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
9656 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
9657 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
9658 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
9659 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
9660 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02009661 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
9662 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
9663 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
9664 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
9665 standard, well-documented behaviour, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009666 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
9667 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009668
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01009669 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
9670 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
9671 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
9672 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
9673 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009674 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009675
9676 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
9677 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
9678 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
9679 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
9680 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
9681
9682 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02009683 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
9684 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
9685 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009686
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009687 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01009688 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009689
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009690
9691timeout queue <timeout>
9692 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
9693 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9694 yes | no | yes | yes
9695 Arguments :
9696 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9697 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9698 as explained at the top of this document.
9699
9700 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
9701 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
9702 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
9703 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
9704 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
9705
9706 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
9707 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
9708 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
9709 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
9710
9711 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
9712
9713
9714timeout server <timeout>
9715timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9716 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
9717 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9718 yes | no | yes | yes
9719 Arguments :
9720 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9721 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9722 as explained at the top of this document.
9723
9724 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
9725 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
9726 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
9727 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
9728 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
9729 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
9730 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
9731
9732 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
9733 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
9734 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
9735 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
9736 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009737 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009738 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009739 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
9740 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
9741 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
9742 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009743
9744 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9745 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9746 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9747 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
9748 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
9749 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9750
9751 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
9752 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
9753 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
9754
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009755 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009756
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009757
9758timeout server-fin <timeout>
9759 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
9760 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9761 yes | no | yes | yes
9762 Arguments :
9763 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9764 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9765 as explained at the top of this document.
9766
9767 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
9768 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
9769 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
9770 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
9771 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
9772 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
9773 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
9774 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
9775 situations, it should not be needed.
9776
9777 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9778 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
9779 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
9780
9781 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
9782
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009783
9784timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01009785 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009786 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9787 yes | yes | yes | yes
9788 Arguments :
9789 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
9790 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9791 as explained at the top of this document.
9792
9793 When a connection is tarpitted using "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with
9794 no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit"
9795 defines how long it will be maintained open.
9796
9797 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
9798 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
9799 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
9800 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01009801 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009802
9803 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
9804
9805
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009806timeout tunnel <timeout>
9807 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
9808 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9809 yes | no | yes | yes
9810 Arguments :
9811 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9812 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9813 as explained at the top of this document.
9814
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009815 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009816 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
9817 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
9818 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
9819 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
9820 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
9821 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
9822 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
9823 specified.
9824
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009825 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
9826 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
9827 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
9828 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
9829 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
9830 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
9831 state.
9832
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009833 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
9834 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
9835 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
9836 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
9837 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
9838
9839 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9840 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9841 forget about it.
9842
9843 Example :
9844 defaults http
9845 option http-server-close
9846 timeout connect 5s
9847 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009848 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009849 timeout server 30s
9850 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
9851
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009852 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009853
9854
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009855transparent (deprecated)
9856 Enable client-side transparent proxying
9857 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01009858 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009859 Arguments : none
9860
9861 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
9862 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
9863 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
9864 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
9865 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
9866 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
9867 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
9868 appropriate server.
9869
9870 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
9871
9872 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
9873 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
9874
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009875 See also: "option transparent"
9876
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009877unique-id-format <string>
9878 Generate a unique ID for each request.
9879 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9880 yes | yes | yes | no
9881 Arguments :
9882 <string> is a log-format string.
9883
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009884 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
9885 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
9886 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
9887 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009888
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009889 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
9890 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
9891 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
9892 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
9893 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
9894 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
9895 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
9896 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009897
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009898 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
9899 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009900
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009901 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009902
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05009903 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009904
9905 will generate:
9906
9907 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
9908
9909 See also: "unique-id-header"
9910
9911unique-id-header <name>
9912 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
9913 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9914 yes | yes | yes | no
9915 Arguments :
9916 <name> is the name of the header.
9917
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009918 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
9919 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009920
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009921 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009922
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -05009923 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01009924 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
9925
9926 will generate:
9927
9928 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
9929
9930 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009931
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02009932use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02009933 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009934 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9935 no | yes | yes | no
9936 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01009937 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
9938 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009939
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +02009940 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
9941 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009942
9943 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
9944 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
9945 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +02009946 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
9947 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
9948 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
9949 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009950
9951 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
9952 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
9953 assign the backend.
9954
9955 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
9956 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
9957 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
9958 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
9959 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
9960 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
9961
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02009962 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009963 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +02009964 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
9965 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
9966 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
9967
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01009968 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
9969 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
9970 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
9971 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
9972 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
9973 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
9974 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
9975 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
9976 cannot be forced from the request.
9977
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009978 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01009979 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
9980 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
9981
9982 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
9983 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009984
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009985
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02009986use-server <server> if <condition>
9987use-server <server> unless <condition>
9988 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
9989 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9990 no | no | yes | yes
9991 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009992 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02009993
9994 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
9995
9996 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
9997 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
9998 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
9999
10000 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
10001 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
10002 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
10003 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
10004 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
10005 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
10006 matches will assign the server.
10007
10008 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
10009 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
10010 with the next rules until one matches.
10011
10012 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
10013 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10014 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
10015 according to other persistence mechanisms.
10016
10017 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
10018 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
10019 stripped.
10020
10021 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
10022 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
10023 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
10024 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
10025
10026 Example :
10027 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
10028 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
10029 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
10030 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
10031 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
10032 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
10033 server mail 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
10034 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
10035 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
10036
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010037 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010038
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010039
100405. Bind and Server options
10041--------------------------
10042
10043The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
10044depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
10045settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
10046written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
10047described in this section.
10048
10049
100505.1. Bind options
10051-----------------
10052
10053The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
10054as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
10055no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
10056parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
10057while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
10058provided immediately after the setting name.
10059
10060The currently supported settings are the following ones.
10061
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010062accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
10063 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
10064 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
10065 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
10066 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
10067 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
10068 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
10069 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
10070 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
10071 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010010072 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
10073 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
10074 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010075
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010076accept-proxy
10077 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020010078 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
10079 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010080 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
10081 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
10082 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
10083 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
10084 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
10085 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
10086 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010087 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
10088 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010089
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010090alpn <protocols>
10091 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
10092 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
10093 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
10094 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
10095 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
10096 initial NPN extension.
10097
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010098backlog <backlog>
10099 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
10100 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
10101
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010010102curves <curves>
10103 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10104 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
10105 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
10106 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
10107 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
10108 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
10109
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010110ecdhe <named curve>
10111 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010010112 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
10113 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010114
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010115ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010116 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10117 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
10118 client's certificate.
10119
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010120ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
10121 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
10122 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
10123 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
10124 error is ignored.
10125
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010126ca-sign-file <cafile>
10127 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10128 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
10129 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
10130 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10131 'generate-certificates' for details.
10132
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000010133ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010134 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
10135 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
10136 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10137 'generate-certificates' for details.
10138
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010139ciphers <ciphers>
10140 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10141 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010142 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010143 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
10144 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
10145
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010146crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010147 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10148 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
10149 to verify client's certificate.
10150
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010151crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010152 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10153 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
10154 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
10155 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
10156 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
10157 file.
10158
10159 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
10160 are loaded.
10161
10162 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010163 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010164 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
10165 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
10166 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
10167 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
10168 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
10169 instead of the first hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches
10170 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010171
10172 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
10173 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
10174 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
10175 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010176 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
10177 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010178
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020010179 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010180
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010181 Some CAs (such as Godaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
10182 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Godbach8bf60a12014-04-21 21:42:41 +080010183 choose a webserver that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010184 Godaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
10185 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
10186 clients).
10187
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020010188 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
10189 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
10190 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
10191 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
10192 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
10193 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
10194 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
10195 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
10196 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
10197 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
10198 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
10199 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
10200 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
10201
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010202 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
10203 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
10204 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
10205 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
10206 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
10207
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010208 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
10209 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
10210 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
10211 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010212
10213 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
10214 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
10215 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
10216 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
10217 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
10218 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
10219 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
10220 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
10221 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
10222
10223 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
10224
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010225 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010226 a cert bundle.
10227
10228 Haproxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
10229 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
10230 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
10231 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
10232 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
10233 provide multi-cert support.
10234
10235 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
10236
10237 Filename | CN | SAN
10238 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
10239 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010240 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010241 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
10242 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
10243
10244 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
10245 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
10246 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
10247 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010010248 suites. With BoringSSL multi-cert is natively supported, no need to bundle
10249 certificates. ECDSA certificate will be preferred if client support it.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010250
10251 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
10252 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
10253
10254 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
10255 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
10256 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
10257
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010258crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010259 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
10260 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010261 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010262 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010263
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010264crt-list <file>
10265 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010266 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
10267 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010268
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010269 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
10270
10271 sslbindconf support "npn", "alpn", "verify", "ca_file", "crl_file", "ecdhe",
Emmanuel Hocdet4608ed92017-01-20 13:06:27 +010010272 "curves", "ciphers" configuration.
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010273 It override the configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010274
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020010275 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
10276 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
10277 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
10278 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
10279 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
10280 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
10281 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
10282 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010283
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010284 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020010285 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010010286 all bundled certificates. With BoringSSL multi-cert is natively supported,
10287 avoid multi-cert bundling. RSA and ECDSA certificates can be declared in a
10288 row, and set different ssl and filter parameter.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010289
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010290 crt-list file example:
10291 cert1.pem
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010010292 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010293 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010010294 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010295
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010296defer-accept
10297 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
10298 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
10299 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
10300 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
10301 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
10302 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
10303 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
10304 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
10305 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
10306 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
10307 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
10308
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010309force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010310 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010311 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010312 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
10313 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*" and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010314
10315force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010316 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010317 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
10318 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*" and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010319
10320force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010321 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010322 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
10323 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*", and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010324
10325force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010326 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010327 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
10328 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "no-tlsv*", and "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010329
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010330generate-certificates
10331 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10332 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
10333 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
10334 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
10335 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
10336 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
10337 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
10338 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
10339 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
10340 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
10341 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
10342
10343 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
10344 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
10345 increases the HAProxy's memroy footprint to reduce latency when the same
10346 certificate is used many times.
10347
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010348gid <gid>
10349 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
10350 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
10351 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
10352 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
10353 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10354
10355group <group>
10356 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
10357 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
10358 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
10359 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
10360 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10361
10362id <id>
10363 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
10364 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
10365 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
10366 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
10367
10368interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010010369 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
10370 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
10371 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
10372 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
10373 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
10374 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
10375 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010376
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020010377level <level>
10378 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
10379 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
10380 sockets. <level> can be one of :
10381 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
10382 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
10383 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
10384 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
10385 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
10386 counters).
10387 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
10388 all counters).
10389
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010390maxconn <maxconn>
10391 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
10392 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
10393 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
10394 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
10395 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
10396 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
10397 eat all memory.
10398
10399mode <mode>
10400 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
10401 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
10402 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
10403 UNIX sockets.
10404
10405mss <maxseg>
10406 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
10407 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
10408 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
10409 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
10410 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
10411 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
10412 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
10413 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
10414 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
10415 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
10416 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
10417
10418name <name>
10419 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
10420 page.
10421
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020010422namespace <name>
10423 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
10424 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
10425 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
10426 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
10427
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010428nice <nice>
10429 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
10430 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
10431 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
10432 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
10433 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
10434 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
10435 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
10436 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
10437 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
10438 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
10439 one for an RDP socket.
10440
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010441no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010442 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010443 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010444 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010445 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
10446 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "force-tls*",
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010447 and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010448
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020010449no-tls-tickets
10450 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10451 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
10452 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010453 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
10454 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020010455
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010456no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010457 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010458 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010459 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010460 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
10461 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
10462 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010463
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010464no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010465 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010466 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010467 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010468 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
10469 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
10470 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010471
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010472no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010473 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010474 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010475 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010476 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
10477 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". See also
10478 "force-tlsv*", and "force-sslv3".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010479
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020010480npn <protocols>
10481 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
10482 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
10483 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
10484 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010485 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
10486 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020010487
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020010488process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ]
10489 This restricts the list of processes on which this listener is allowed to
10490 run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do not match.
10491 If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection between the
10492 two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run on any
10493 remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either run on
10494 the first process of the listener if a single process was specified, or on
10495 all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. For the unlikely
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +020010496 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated. The
10497 main purpose of this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have
10498 one different socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind
10499 lines sharing the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so
10500 that the system can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues
10501 and allow a smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and
10502 above is known for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020010503
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010504ssl
10505 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010506 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010507 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
10508 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
10509 to deciphered contents.
10510
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010010511strict-sni
10512 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
10513 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
10514 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
10515 See the "crt" option for more information.
10516
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010010517tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010010518 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010010519 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
10520 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010010521 receiving an acknowledgement for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010010522 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
10523 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
10524 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
10525 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
10526 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
10527 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
10528 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
10529
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020010530tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010010531 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020010532 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
10533 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
10534 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
10535 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
10536 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
10537 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
10538 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020010539 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
10540 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
10541 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020010542
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010010543tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
10544 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
10545 bytes long, encoded with base64 (ex. openssl rand -base64 48). Number of keys
10546 is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO build option (default 3) and at least as
10547 many keys need to be present in the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be
10548 used for decryption and the penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy
10549 key rotation by just appending new key to the file and reloading the process.
10550 Keys must be periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy
10551 is compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
10552 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
10553 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
10554
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010555transparent
10556 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
10557 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
10558 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
10559 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
10560 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
10561 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
10562 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
10563 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
10564 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
10565 so check for support with your vendor.
10566
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010010567v4v6
10568 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
10569 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
10570 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
10571 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010572 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010010573
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010010574v6only
10575 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
10576 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
10577 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010010578 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
10579 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010010580
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010581uid <uid>
10582 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
10583 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
10584 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
10585 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
10586 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10587
10588user <user>
10589 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
10590 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
10591 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
10592 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
10593 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10594
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010595verify [none|optional|required]
10596 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
10597 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
10598 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
10599 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
10600 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010601 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
10602 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
10603 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
10604 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010605
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200106065.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010010607------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010608
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010010609The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
10610which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
10611arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
10612settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
10613after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
10614Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
10615address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010616
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010617 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010010618 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010619
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010620The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010621
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020010622addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010623 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010010624 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
10625 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
10626 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
10627 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
10628 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010629
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010630 Supported in default-server: No
10631
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010632agent-check
10633 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010634 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
10635 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string.
10636 The string is made of a series of words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas
10637 in any order, optionally terminated by '\r' and/or '\n', each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010638
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010639 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010640 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020010641 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
10642 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
10643 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010644
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020010645 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values in
10646 this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
10647 connections advertised needs to be multipled by the number of load balancers
10648 and different backends that use this health check to get the total number
10649 of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
10650
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010651 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
10652 READY mode, thus cancelling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010653
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010654 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
10655 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
10656 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010657
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010658 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
10659 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
10660 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010661
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010662 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
10663 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
10664 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
10665 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
10666 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
10667 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (eg: missing process,
10668 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010669
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010670 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
10671 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010672
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010673 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
10674 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
10675 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
10676 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
10677 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
10678 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
10679 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
10680 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
10681 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010682
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090010683 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
10684 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010685 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
10686 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
10687 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010010688 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090010689
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010690 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
10691 parameter.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010692
10693 Supported in default-server: No
10694
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070010695agent-send <string>
10696 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
10697 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
10698 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
10699 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
10700 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
10701
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010702agent-inter <delay>
10703 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
10704 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
10705
10706 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
10707 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
10708 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
10709 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
10710 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
10711 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
10712 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
10713 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
10714 of backends use the same servers.
10715
10716 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
10717
10718 Supported in default-server: Yes
10719
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010010720agent-addr <addr>
10721 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
10722
10723 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
10724 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
10725 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
10726 hostname, it will be resolved.
10727
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010728agent-port <port>
10729 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
10730
10731 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
10732
10733 Supported in default-server: Yes
10734
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010735backup
10736 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
10737 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
10738 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
10739 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
10740 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "allbackups"
10741 option.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010742
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010743 Supported in default-server: No
10744
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020010745ca-file <cafile>
10746 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10747 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
10748 server's certificate.
10749
10750 Supported in default-server: No
10751
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010752check
10753 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +010010754 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
10755 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
10756 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
10757 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
10758 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
10759 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
10760 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090010761 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
10762 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
10763 refer to those options and parameters for more information.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010764
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010765 Supported in default-server: No
10766
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020010767check-send-proxy
10768 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
10769 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
10770 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
10771 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
10772 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
10773 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
10774 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
10775
10776 Supported in default-server: No
10777
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010778check-ssl
10779 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
10780 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
10781 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
10782 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010783 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010784 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
10785 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
10786 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
10787 See the "ssl" option for more information.
10788
10789 Supported in default-server: No
10790
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010791ciphers <ciphers>
10792 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010793 is negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010794 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
10795 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
10796 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
10797 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
10798 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
10799 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
10800
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010801 Supported in default-server: No
10802
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010803cookie <value>
10804 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
10805 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
10806 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
10807 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
10808 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
10809 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
10810 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
10811
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010812 Supported in default-server: No
10813
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020010814crl-file <crlfile>
10815 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10816 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
10817 to verify server's certificate.
10818
10819 Supported in default-server: No
10820
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020010821crt <cert>
10822 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
10823 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
10824 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
10825 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
10826 certificate request.
10827
10828 Supported in default-server: No
10829
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020010830disabled
10831 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
10832 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
10833 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
10834 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
10835 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
10836
10837 Supported in default-server: No
10838
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010839error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010010840 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
10841 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
10842 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010843
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010844 Supported in default-server: Yes
10845
10846 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010847
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010848fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010849 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
10850 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
10851 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
10852
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010853 Supported in default-server: Yes
10854
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010855force-sslv3
10856 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
10857 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010858 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
10859 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010860
10861 Supported in default-server: No
10862
10863force-tlsv10
10864 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010865 the server. This option is also available on global statement
10866 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010867
10868 Supported in default-server: No
10869
10870force-tlsv11
10871 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010872 the server. This option is also available on global statement
10873 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010874
10875 Supported in default-server: No
10876
10877force-tlsv12
10878 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010879 the server. This option is also available on global statement
10880 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "no-tlsv*", "no-sslv3".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020010881
10882 Supported in default-server: No
10883
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010884id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020010885 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
10886 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
10887 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010888
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010889 Supported in default-server: No
10890
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010010891init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
10892 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
10893 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
10894 turn each of the methods mentionned in the comma-delimited list. The first
10895 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
10896 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
10897 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
10898 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
10899 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
10900 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
10901 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
10902 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
10903 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
10904 server (eg: filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
10905 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
10906 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
10907 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
10908 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
10909 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
10910 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
10911 historic behaviour.
10912
10913 Example:
10914 defaults
10915 # never fail on address resolution
10916 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
10917
10918 Supported in default-server: Yes
10919
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010920inter <delay>
10921fastinter <delay>
10922downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010923 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
10924 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
10925 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
10926 between checks depending on the server state :
10927
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020010928 Server state | Interval used
10929 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
10930 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
10931 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
10932 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
10933 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
10934 or yet unchecked. |
10935 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
10936 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
10937 | "inter" otherwise.
10938 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010939
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010940 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
10941 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
10942 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
10943 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010944 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
10945 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
10946 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
10947 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
10948 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010949
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010950 Supported in default-server: Yes
10951
10952maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010953 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
10954 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
10955 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
10956 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
10957 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
10958 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
10959 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
10960 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
10961
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010962 Supported in default-server: Yes
10963
10964maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010965 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
10966 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
10967 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
10968 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
10969 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
10970 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
10971 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
10972
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010973 Supported in default-server: Yes
10974
10975minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010976 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
10977 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
10978 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
10979 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
10980 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
10981 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010982 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010983 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010984
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010985 Supported in default-server: Yes
10986
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020010987namespace <name>
10988 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
10989 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
10990 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
10991 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
10992
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010010993no-ssl-reuse
10994 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
10995 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
10996 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
10997 and for paranoid users.
10998
10999 Supported in default-server: No
11000
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011001no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011002 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
11003 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011004 using any configuration option. See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011005
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011006 Supported in default-server: No
11007
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020011008no-tls-tickets
11009 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11010 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11011 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011012 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
11013 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020011014
11015 Supported in default-server: No
11016
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011017no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011018 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011019 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11020 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011021 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11022 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
11023 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011024
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011025 Supported in default-server: No
11026
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011027no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011028 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011029 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11030 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011031 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11032 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
11033 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011034
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011035 Supported in default-server: No
11036
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011037no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011038 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011039 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11040 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011041 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11042 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
11043 See also "force-sslv3", "force-tlsv*".
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011044
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011045 Supported in default-server: No
11046
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090011047non-stick
11048 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
11049 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
11050 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
11051
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011052 Supported in default-server: No
11053
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011054observe <mode>
11055 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
11056 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
11057 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
11058 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
11059 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
11060 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010011061 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011062
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011063 Supported in default-server: No
11064
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011065 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
11066
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011067on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011068 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
11069 Currently, four modes are available:
11070 - fastinter: force fastinter
11071 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
11072 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
11073 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
11074 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
11075
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011076 Supported in default-server: Yes
11077
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011078 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
11079
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090011080on-marked-down <action>
11081 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
11082 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011083 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
11084 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
11085 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
11086 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
11087 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
11088 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
11089 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
11090 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090011091
11092 Actions are disabled by default
11093
11094 Supported in default-server: Yes
11095
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011096on-marked-up <action>
11097 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
11098 Currently one action is available:
11099 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
11100 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
11101 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
11102 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
11103 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
11104 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
11105 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
11106 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
11107
11108 Actions are disabled by default
11109
11110 Supported in default-server: Yes
11111
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011112port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011113 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
11114 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
11115 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
11116 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
11117 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
11118 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
11119
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011120 Supported in default-server: Yes
11121
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011122redir <prefix>
11123 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
11124 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
11125 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
11126 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
11127 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
11128 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
11129 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
11130 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011131 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011132 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
11133 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
11134 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
11135 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
11136 loop between the client and HAProxy!
11137
11138 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
11139
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011140 Supported in default-server: No
11141
11142rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011143 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
11144 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
11145 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
11146
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011147 Supported in default-server: Yes
11148
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011149resolve-prefer <family>
11150 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
11151 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
11152 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
11153 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
11154
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020011155 Default value: ipv6
11156
11157 Supported in default-server: Yes
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011158
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011159 Example:
11160
11161 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011162
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010011163resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
11164 This options prioritize th choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
11165 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011166 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010011167 differents datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
11168 this patch permitsto prefers a local datacenter. If none address matchs the
11169 configured network, another address is selected.
11170
11171 Supported in default-server: Yes
11172
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011173 Example:
11174
11175 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010011176
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011177resolvers <id>
11178 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
11179 hostname.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011180 In order to be operational, DNS resolution requires that health check is
11181 enabled on the server. Actually, health checks triggers the DNS resolution.
11182 You must precise one 'resolvers' parameter on each server line where DNS
11183 resolution is required.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011184
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011185 Supported in default-server: No
11186
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011187 Example:
11188
11189 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011190
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011191 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011192
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010011193send-proxy
11194 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
11195 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
11196 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
11197 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010011198 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
11199 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
11200 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
11201 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
11202 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
11203 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
11204 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
11205 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
11206 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
11207 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
11208 See also the "accept-proxy" and "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind"
11209 keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010011210
11211 Supported in default-server: No
11212
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011213send-proxy-v2
11214 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
11215 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
11216 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
11217 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
11218 whatever the upper layer protocol. This setting must not be used if the
11219 server isn't aware of this version of the protocol. See also the "send-proxy"
11220 option of the "bind" keyword.
11221
11222 Supported in default-server: No
11223
11224send-proxy-v2-ssl
11225 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
11226 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
11227 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
11228 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
11229 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
11230 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
11231 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
11232 See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
11233
11234 Supported in default-server: No
11235
11236send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
11237 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
11238 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
11239 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
11240 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
11241 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
11242 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
11243 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
11244 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
11245 protocol. See also the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
11246
11247 Supported in default-server: No
11248
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011249slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011250 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
11251 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
11252 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
11253 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
11254 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
11255 parameters :
11256
11257 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
11258 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
11259
11260 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
11261 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
11262 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
11263 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
11264
11265 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
11266 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
11267 seen as failed.
11268
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011269 Supported in default-server: Yes
11270
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020011271sni <expression>
11272 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
11273 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
11274 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
11275 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
11276 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense.
11277
11278 Supported in default-server: no
11279
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020011280source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020011281source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020011282source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011283 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
11284 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
11285 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
11286 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
11287
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020011288 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
11289 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
11290 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
11291 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
11292 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
11293 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
11294 server.
11295
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000011296 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
11297 specifying the source address without port(s).
11298
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011299 Supported in default-server: No
11300
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011301ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020011302 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
11303 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
11304 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
11305 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
11306 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
11307 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011308 See the "check-ssl" option to force SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011309
11310 Supported in default-server: No
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011311
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020011312tcp-ut <delay>
11313 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
11314 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
11315 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011316 acknowledgement for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020011317 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
11318 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
11319 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
11320 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
11321 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
11322 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
11323 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
11324 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
11325 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
11326
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011327track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020011328 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
11329 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
11330 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
11331 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011332 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
11333
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011334 Supported in default-server: No
11335
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011336verify [none|required]
11337 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010011338 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
11339 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file'
11340 and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. If 'ssl_server_verify' is not specified
11341 in global section, this is the default. On verify failure the handshake
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020011342 is aborted. It is critically important to verify server certificates when
11343 using SSL to connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to
11344 trivial man-in-the-middle attacks rendering SSL totally useless.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011345
11346 Supported in default-server: No
11347
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070011348verifyhost <hostname>
11349 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
11350 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. When set, the
11351 hostnames in the subject and subjectAlternateNames of the certificate
11352 provided by the server are checked. If none of the hostnames in the
11353 certificate match the specified hostname, the handshake is aborted. The
11354 hostnames in the server-provided certificate may include wildcards.
11355
11356 Supported in default-server: No
11357
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011358weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011359 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
11360 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
11361 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020011362 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
11363 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
11364 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
11365 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
11366 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
11367 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011368
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011369 Supported in default-server: Yes
11370
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011371
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200113725.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
11373-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011374
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011375HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
11376using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
11377configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011378This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
11379can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
11380workload.
11381This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
11382resolution at run time.
11383Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
11384carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
11385
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011386Bear in mind that DNS resolution is triggered by health checks. This makes
11387health checks mandatory to allow DNS resolution.
11388
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011389
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200113905.3.1. Global overview
11391----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011392
11393As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
11394different steps of the process life:
11395
11396 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
11397 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
11398 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
11399
11400 2. at run time, when HAProxy gets prepared to run a health check on a server,
11401 it verifies if the current name resolution is still considered as valid.
11402 If not, it processes a new resolution, in parallel of the health check.
11403
11404A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
11405 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
11406 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
11407 resolution to know this new IP.
11408
11409A few things important to notice:
11410 - all the name servers are queried in the mean time. HAProxy will process the
11411 first valid response.
11412
11413 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
11414 servers return an error.
11415
11416
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200114175.3.2. The resolvers section
11418----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011419
11420This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
11421HAProxy.
11422There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can contain
11423many name servers.
11424
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011425When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
11426uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
11427is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
11428answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
11429
11430When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
11431used by HAProxy to decide what type of behavior to apply.
11432
11433Two types of behavior can be applied:
11434 1. stop DNS resolution
11435 2. replay the DNS query with a new query type
11436 In such case, the following types are applied in this exact order:
11437 1. ANY query type
11438 2. query type corresponding to family pointed by resolve-prefer
11439 server's parameter
11440 3. remaining family type
11441
11442HAProxy stops DNS resolution when the following errors occur:
11443 - invalid DNS response packet
11444 - wrong name in the query section of the response
11445 - NX domain
11446 - Query refused by server
11447 - CNAME not pointing to an IP address
11448
11449HAProxy tries a new query type when the following errors occur:
11450 - no Answer records in the response
11451 - DNS response truncated
11452 - Error in DNS response
11453 - No expected DNS records found in the response
11454 - name server timeout
11455
11456For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section:
11457 - first response is valid and is applied directly, second response is ignored
11458 - first response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
11459 applied;
11460 - first response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
11461 HAProxy replays the query with a new type;
11462 - first response is truncated and second one is a NX Domain, then HAProxy
11463 stops resolution.
11464
11465
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011466resolvers <resolvers id>
11467 Creates a new name server list labelled <resolvers id>
11468
11469A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
11470
11471nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
11472 DNS server description:
11473 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
11474 <ip> : IP address of the server
11475 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
11476
11477hold <status> <period>
11478 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
11479 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010011480 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
11481 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011482 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
11483 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
11484 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
11485
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010011486 Default value is 10s for "valid" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011487
11488 Note: since the name resolution is triggered by the health checks, a new
11489 resolution is triggered after <period> modulo the <inter> parameter of
11490 the healch check.
11491
11492resolve_retries <nb>
11493 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
11494 giving up.
11495 Default value: 3
11496
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011497 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
11498 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
11499 type.
11500
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011501timeout <event> <time>
11502 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
11503 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
11504 events available are:
11505 - retry: time between two DNS queries, when no response have
11506 been received.
11507 Default value: 1s
11508 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
11509 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
11510
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011511 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011512
11513 resolvers mydns
11514 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
11515 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
11516 resolve_retries 3
11517 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010011518 hold other 30s
11519 hold refused 30s
11520 hold nx 30s
11521 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011522 hold valid 10s
11523
11524
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200115256. HTTP header manipulation
11526---------------------------
11527
11528In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
11529response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
11530request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
11531which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010011532against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011533
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010011534If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
11535to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
11536but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
11537HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
11538stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
11539because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
11540a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
11541still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +020011542
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011543This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
11544in section 4.2 :
11545
11546 - reqadd <string>
11547 - reqallow <search>
11548 - reqiallow <search>
11549 - reqdel <search>
11550 - reqidel <search>
11551 - reqdeny <search>
11552 - reqideny <search>
11553 - reqpass <search>
11554 - reqipass <search>
11555 - reqrep <search> <replace>
11556 - reqirep <search> <replace>
11557 - reqtarpit <search>
11558 - reqitarpit <search>
11559 - rspadd <string>
11560 - rspdel <search>
11561 - rspidel <search>
11562 - rspdeny <search>
11563 - rspideny <search>
11564 - rsprep <search> <replace>
11565 - rspirep <search> <replace>
11566
11567With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
11568is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
11569parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
11570prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
11571Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
11572
11573 \t for a tab
11574 \r for a carriage return (CR)
11575 \n for a new line (LF)
11576 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
11577 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
11578 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
11579 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
11580 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
11581
11582The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
11583portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
11584above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
11585regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
115869 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
11587is very common to users of the "sed" program.
11588
11589The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
11590after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
11591
11592Notes related to these keywords :
11593---------------------------------
11594 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
11595 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
11596 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
11597
11598 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
11599 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
11600 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
11601
11602 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
11603 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
11604 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
11605 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
11606 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
11607
11608 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
11609 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
11610 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
11611 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
11612 useless headers before adding new ones.
11613
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011614 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011615 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
11616
11617 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
11618 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
11619 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
11620
11621 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
11622 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011623 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011624
11625
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200116267. Using ACLs and fetching samples
11627----------------------------------
11628
11629Haproxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
11630client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
11631The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
11632these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
11633but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
11634data called patterns.
11635
11636
116377.1. ACL basics
11638---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011639
11640The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
11641content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
11642from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
11643simple :
11644
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011645 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011646 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011647 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
11648 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011649
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011650The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
11651adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011652
11653In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
11654
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011655 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011656
11657This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
11658Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
11659and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011660an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
11661conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
11662as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
11663are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011664
11665ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
11666'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
11667which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
11668
11669There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
11670performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
11671
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011672The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
11673specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
11674this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011675methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
11676ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011677
11678Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
11679 - boolean
11680 - integer (signed or unsigned)
11681 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
11682 - string
11683 - data block
11684
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011685Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
11686converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
11687would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
11688The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
11689which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
11690
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011691Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
11692keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
11693fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
11694which are summarized in the table below :
11695
11696 +---------------------+-----------------+
11697 | Sample or converter | Default |
11698 | output type | matching method |
11699 +---------------------+-----------------+
11700 | boolean | bool |
11701 +---------------------+-----------------+
11702 | integer | int |
11703 +---------------------+-----------------+
11704 | ip | ip |
11705 +---------------------+-----------------+
11706 | string | str |
11707 +---------------------+-----------------+
11708 | binary | none, use "-m" |
11709 +---------------------+-----------------+
11710
11711Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
11712matching method, see below.
11713
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011714The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
11715 - boolean
11716 - integer or integer range
11717 - IP address / network
11718 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
11719 - regular expression
11720 - hex block
11721
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011722The following ACL flags are currently supported :
11723
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011724 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
11725 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011726 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010011727 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010011728 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010011729 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011730 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
11731
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011732The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
11733read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
11734if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
11735lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
11736will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
11737beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
11738a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
11739lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
11740exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
11741
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010011742The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
11743parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
11744ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
11745a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
11746check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
11747
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010011748The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
11749socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
11750file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
11751
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011752Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
11753loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
11754
11755 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
11756
11757In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
11758the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
11759case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
11760as well.
11761
11762The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
11763sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
11764do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
11765methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
11766is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
11767obvious matching method (eg: string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
11768followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
11769default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
11770that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
11771string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
11772
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010011773The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
11774By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
11775string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
11776resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
11777server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
11778waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
11779flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
11780function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
11781
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011782There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
11783sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
11784be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011785
11786 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
11787 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011788 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
11789 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
11790 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
11791 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011792
11793 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
11794 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011795 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011796
11797 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011798 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011799
11800 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011801 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011802
11803 - "bin" : match the contents against an hexadecimal string representing a
11804 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
11805
11806 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
11807 binary or string samples.
11808
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011809 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
11810 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011811
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011812 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
11813 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
11814 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011815
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011816 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
11817 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011818
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011819 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
11820 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011821
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011822 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
11823 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011824
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011825 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
11826 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011827 This may be used with binary or string samples.
11828
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011829 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
11830 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
11831 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011832
11833For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
11834request, it is possible to do :
11835
11836 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
11837
11838In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
11839buffer, one would use the following acl :
11840
11841 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
11842
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011843On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
11844possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
11845
11846 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
11847
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011848All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
11849criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
11850method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
11851to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
11852criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
11853the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011854
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011855If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011856the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
11857For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011858
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011859 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
11860 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
11861 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
11862 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011863
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011864
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011865The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
11866types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
11867combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
11868brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
11869default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011870
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011871 +-------------------------------------------------+
11872 | Input sample type |
11873 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011874 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011875 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
11876 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
11877 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011878 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011879 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011880 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011881 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011882 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011883 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011884 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011885 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011886 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011887 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011888 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011889 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011890 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011891 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011892 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011893 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011894 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011895 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011896 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011897 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010011898 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011899 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
11900 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
11901 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011902
11903
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200119047.1.1. Matching booleans
11905------------------------
11906
11907In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
11908Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
11909When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
11910that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
11911
11912Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
11913return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
11914"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
11915
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011916
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200119177.1.2. Matching integers
11918------------------------
11919
11920Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
11921enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
11922to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
11923
11924Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
11925matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
11926lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011927
11928For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
11929unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
11930representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
11931
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011932As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
11933two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
11934instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
11935ranges and operators.
11936
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011937For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011938operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
11939Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
11940of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011941
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011942Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011943
11944 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
11945 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
11946 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
11947 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
11948 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
11949
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011950For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011951
11952 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
11953
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011954This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
11955
11956 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
11957
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011958
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200119597.1.3. Matching strings
11960-----------------------
11961
11962String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
11963different forms :
11964
11965 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
11966 patterns ;
11967
11968 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
11969 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside ;
11970
11971 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
11972 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
11973
11974 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
11975 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
11976
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010011977 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011978 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
11979 matches.
11980
11981 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
11982 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
11983 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011984
11985String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
11986exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
11987characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
11988string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
11989to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011990before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011991
11992
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200119937.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
11994---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011995
11996Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
11997they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
11998possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
11999passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
12000the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012001the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
12002match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012003
12004
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200120057.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
12006-------------------------------------
12007
12008It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
12009not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
12010a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
12011to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
12012digits may be used upper or lower case.
12013
12014Example :
12015 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
12016 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
12017
12018
120197.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
12020---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012021
12022IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
12023netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
12024within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012025host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012026difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
12027at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
12028does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
12029parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012030
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020012031The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
12032abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
12033
12034 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12035 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
12036 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12037 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
12038 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
12039 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
12040 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
12041 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12042
12043Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
12044192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
12045
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020012046IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
12047Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
12048trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
12049IPv6 patterns.
12050
12051HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
12052following situations :
12053 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
12054 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
12055 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
12056 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
12057 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
12058 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
12059 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
12060 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
12061 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
12062 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
12063
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012064
120657.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
12066----------------------------------
12067
12068Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
12069combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
12070
12071 - AND (implicit)
12072 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
12073 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012074
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012075A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012076
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012077 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020012078
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012079Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
12080indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020012081
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012082For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
12083"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
12084requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
12085is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
12086
12087 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
12088 block if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
12089 block if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
12090 block unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
12091
12092To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
12093and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
12094
12095 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
12096 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
12097 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
12098 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
12099
12100 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
12101 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
12102 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
12103 use_backend www if host_www
12104
12105It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
12106expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
12107be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
12108the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
12109
12110 The following rule :
12111
12112 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
12113 block if METH_POST missing_cl
12114
12115 Can also be written that way :
12116
12117 block if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
12118
12119It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
12120to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
12121simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
12122sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
12123good use is the following :
12124
12125 With named ACLs :
12126
12127 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
12128 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
12129 monitor fail if site_dead
12130
12131 With anonymous ACLs :
12132
12133 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
12134
12135See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "block" and "use_backend" keywords.
12136
12137
121387.3. Fetching samples
12139---------------------
12140
12141Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
12142against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
12143sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
12144ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
12145of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
12146available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
12147
12148This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
12149Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
12150compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
12151deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
12152
12153The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
12154matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
12155method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
12156indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
12157
12158As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
12159when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
12160mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
12161the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
12162ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
12163
12164Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
12165multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
12166when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
12167incorrect argument (eg: an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
12168are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
12169is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
12170all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
12171
12172Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
12173 - name
12174 - name(arg1)
12175 - name(arg1,arg2)
12176
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012177
121787.3.1. Converters
12179-----------------
12180
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012181Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
12182of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
12183is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
12184was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
12185has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (acls, log-format,
12186unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
12187
12188These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
12189sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
12190the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
12191support some arguments (eg: a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012192
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012193A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
12194support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
12195supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
12196(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
12197bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
12198
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012199The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012200
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001220151d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
12202 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
12203 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
12204 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
12205 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
12206 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
12207
12208 Example :
12209 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
12210 # containg values for the three properties requested by using the
12211 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
12212 frontend http-in
12213 bind *:8081
12214 default_backend servers
12215 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
12216 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
12217
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012218add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012219 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012220 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012221 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
12222 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012223 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012224 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12225 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12226 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12227 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12228 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012229 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012230
12231and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012232 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012233 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012234 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
12235 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012236 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012237 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12238 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12239 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12240 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12241 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012242 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012243
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020012244base64
12245 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
12246 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg:
12247 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
12248
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012249bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012250 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012251 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
12252 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (eg: verify the
12253 presence of a flag).
12254
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010012255bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
12256 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
12257 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012258 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010012259
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012260cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012261 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
12262 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012263
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010012264crc32([<avalanche>])
12265 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
12266 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12267 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12268 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
12269 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
12270 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
12271 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
12272 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
12273 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
12274 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
12275 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6" and the "hash-type" directive.
12276
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010012277da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020012278 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
12279 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
12280 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
12281 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000012282 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020012283 configuration language.
12284
12285 Example:
12286 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020012287 bind *:8881
12288 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000012289 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020012290
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020012291debug
12292 This converter is used as debug tool. It dumps on screen the content and the
12293 type of the input sample. The sample is returned as is on its output. This
12294 converter only exists when haproxy was built with debugging enabled.
12295
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012296div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012297 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
12298 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012299 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012300 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
12301 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012302 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012303 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12304 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12305 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12306 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12307 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012308 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012309
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012310djb2([<avalanche>])
12311 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
12312 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12313 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12314 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
12315 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
12316 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
12317 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010012318 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6" and the
12319 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012320
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012321even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012322 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012323 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
12324
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010012325field(<index>,<delimiters>)
12326 Extracts the substring at the given index considering given delimiters from
12327 an input string. Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted
12328 list of chars.
12329
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012330hex
12331 Converts a binary input sample to an hex string containing two hex digits per
12332 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
12333 in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg: an SSL ID can be copied in a
12334 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010012335
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012336http_date([<offset>])
12337 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
12338 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
12339 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
12340 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
12341 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
12342 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012343
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020012344in_table(<table>)
12345 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12346 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
12347 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
12348 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (eg: whether
12349 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
12350
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020012351ipmask(<mask>)
12352 Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
12353 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
12354 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask can be passed in
12355 dotted form (eg: 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
12356
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012357json([<input-code>])
12358 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII ouput string ready to use as a
12359 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020012360 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012361 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
12362 of errors:
12363 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
12364 bytes, ...)
12365 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
12366 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
12367
12368 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
12369 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
12370 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
12371 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
12372 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
12373 are :
12374 - "ascii" : never fails ;
12375 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors ;
12376 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors ;
12377 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
12378 error ;
12379 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
12380 characters corresponding to the other errors.
12381
12382 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
12383 logging to servers which consume JSON-formated traffic logs.
12384
12385 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012386 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020012387 capture request header user-agent len 150
12388 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012389
12390 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
12391 GET / HTTP/1.0
12392 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
12393
12394 Output log:
12395 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
12396
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012397language(<value>[,<default>])
12398 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
12399 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
12400 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
12401 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
12402 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
12403 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
12404 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
12405 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
12406 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
12407 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
12408 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
12409 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012410
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012411 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012412
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012413 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
12414 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012415
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012416 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
12417 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
12418 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
12419 use_backend spanish if es
12420 use_backend french if fr
12421 use_backend english if en
12422 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012423
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020012424lower
12425 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
12426 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
12427 type. The result is of type string.
12428
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020012429ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
12430 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
12431 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
12432 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
12433 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
12434 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
12435 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
12436
12437 Example :
12438
12439 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
12440 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
12441 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
12442
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012443map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
12444map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
12445map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
12446 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
12447 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
12448 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
12449 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
12450 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
12451 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
12452 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
12453 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012454
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012455 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
12456 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
12457 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012458
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012459 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012460 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012461
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012462 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
12463 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12464 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
12465 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020012466 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
12467 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012468 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
12469 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12470 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
12471 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12472 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
12473 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12474 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
12475 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080012476 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
12477 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12478 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012479 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12480 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
12481 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12482 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
12483 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012484
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010012485 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
12486 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
12487 the corresponding match text.
12488
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012489 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
12490 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
12491 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
12492 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
12493 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012494
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012495 Example :
12496
12497 # this is a comment and is ignored
12498 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
12499 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
12500 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
12501 | | | `---------- value
12502 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
12503 | `---------------------------- key
12504 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
12505
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012506mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012507 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
12508 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012509 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012510 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012511 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012512 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12513 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12514 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12515 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12516 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012517 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012518
12519mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012520 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020012521 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
12522 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012523 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012524 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012525 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012526 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12527 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12528 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12529 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12530 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012531 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012532
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010012533nbsrv
12534 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
12535 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
12536 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
12537 map lookup.
12538
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012539neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012540 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
12541 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
12542 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
12543 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012544
12545not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012546 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012547 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
12548 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (eg: verify the
12549 absence of a flag).
12550
12551odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012552 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012553 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
12554
12555or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012556 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012557 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012558 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
12559 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012560 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012561 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12562 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12563 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12564 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12565 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012566 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012567
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010012568regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010012569 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
12570 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
12571 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
12572 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
12573 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
12574 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
12575 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
12576 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
12577 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
12578 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
Baptiste Assmann66025d82016-03-06 23:36:48 +010012579 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis, closing
12580 square brackets or comma are not possible to use in the arguments. The first
12581 use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence of
12582 characters with other ones.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010012583
12584 Example :
12585
12586 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
12587 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
12588 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
12589 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
12590
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020012591capture-req(<id>)
12592 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
12593 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
12594
12595 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020012596 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
12597 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020012598
12599capture-res(<id>)
12600 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
12601 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
12602
12603 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020012604 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
12605 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020012606
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012607sdbm([<avalanche>])
12608 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
12609 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12610 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12611 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
12612 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
12613 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
12614 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010012615 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6" and the
12616 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012617
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012618set-var(<var name>)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012619 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output as
12620 is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of the
12621 variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012622 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012623 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12624 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012625 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012626 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
12627 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012628 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012629 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012630
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012631sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012632 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
12633 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012634 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012635 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
12636 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012637 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012638 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12639 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012640 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012641 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
12642 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012643 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012644 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012645
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020012646table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
12647 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12648 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12649 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
12650 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
12651 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
12652 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
12653
12654
12655table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
12656 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12657 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12658 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
12659 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
12660 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
12661 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
12662
12663table_conn_cnt(<table>)
12664 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12665 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12666 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
12667 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
12668 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
12669
12670table_conn_cur(<table>)
12671 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12672 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12673 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
12674 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
12675 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
12676
12677table_conn_rate(<table>)
12678 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12679 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12680 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
12681 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
12682 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
12683
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012684table_gpt0(<table>)
12685 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12686 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
12687 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
12688 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
12689 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
12690
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020012691table_gpc0(<table>)
12692 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12693 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12694 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
12695 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
12696 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
12697
12698table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
12699 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12700 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12701 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
12702 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
12703 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
12704 sample fetch keyword.
12705
12706table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
12707 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12708 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12709 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
12710 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
12711 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
12712
12713table_http_err_rate(<table>)
12714 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12715 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12716 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
12717 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
12718 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
12719 keyword.
12720
12721table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
12722 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12723 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12724 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
12725 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
12726 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
12727
12728table_http_req_rate(<table>)
12729 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12730 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12731 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
12732 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
12733 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
12734 keyword.
12735
12736table_kbytes_in(<table>)
12737 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12738 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12739 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of client-
12740 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
12741 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
12742 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
12743 keyword.
12744
12745table_kbytes_out(<table>)
12746 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12747 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12748 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of server-
12749 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
12750 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
12751 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
12752 keyword.
12753
12754table_server_id(<table>)
12755 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12756 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12757 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
12758 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
12759 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
12760 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
12761
12762table_sess_cnt(<table>)
12763 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12764 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12765 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
12766 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
12767 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
12768 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
12769 keyword.
12770
12771table_sess_rate(<table>)
12772 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12773 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12774 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
12775 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
12776 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
12777 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
12778 keyword.
12779
12780table_trackers(<table>)
12781 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12782 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12783 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
12784 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
12785 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
12786 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
12787 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
12788 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
12789 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
12790 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
12791
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020012792upper
12793 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
12794 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
12795 type. The result is of type string.
12796
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020012797url_dec
12798 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded
12799 version as output. The input and the output are of type string.
12800
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012801unset-var(<var name>)
12802 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
12803 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
12804 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
12805 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12806 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
12807 response),
12808 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
12809 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
12810 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
12811 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
12812
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020012813utime(<format>[,<offset>])
12814 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
12815 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
12816 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
12817 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
12818 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
12819 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
12820
12821 Example :
12822
12823 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
12824 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
12825 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
12826
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010012827word(<index>,<delimiters>)
12828 Extracts the nth word considering given delimiters from an input string.
12829 Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
12830
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012831wt6([<avalanche>])
12832 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
12833 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12834 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12835 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
12836 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
12837 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
12838 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010012839 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", and the
12840 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012841
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012842xor(<value>)
12843 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012844 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012845 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012846 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012847 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012848 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12849 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012850 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012851 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
12852 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012853 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012854 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012855
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010012856xxh32([<seed>])
12857 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
12858 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
12859 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
12860 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
12861 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
12862 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
12863 as cryptographically secure.
12864
12865xxh64([<seed>])
12866 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
12867 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
12868 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
12869 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
12870 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
12871 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
12872 as cryptographically secure.
12873
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012874
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200128757.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012876--------------------------------------------
12877
12878A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
12879not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
12880"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
12881The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
12882
12883always_false : boolean
12884 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
12885 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
12886
12887always_true : boolean
12888 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
12889 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
12890
12891avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012892 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012893 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
12894 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
12895 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
12896 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
12897 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
12898 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
12899 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
12900 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
12901 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
12902 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
12903 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
12904 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
12905 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010012906
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012907be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020012908 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
12909 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
12910 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
12911 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
12912 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012913
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012914be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
12915 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
12916 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
12917 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
12918 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent sucking of an
12919 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
12920 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012921
12922 Example :
12923 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
12924 backend dynamic
12925 mode http
12926 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
12927 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012928
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020012929bin(<hexa>) : bin
12930 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
12931 of the string.
12932
12933bool(<bool>) : bool
12934 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
12935 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
12936
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012937connslots([<backend>]) : integer
12938 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012939 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012940 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
12941 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050012942
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080012943 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012944 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080012945 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
12946
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012947 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
12948 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080012949
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020012950 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012951 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012952 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012953 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
12954 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012955 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020012956 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080012957
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012958 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
12959 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012960 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012961 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080012962
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020012963date([<offset>]) : integer
12964 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
12965 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
12966 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
12967 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020012968 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
12969
12970 Example :
12971
12972 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
12973 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020012974
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020012975env(<name>) : string
12976 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
12977 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
12978 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
12979 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
12980 certain way.
12981
12982 Examples :
12983 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
12984 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
12985
12986 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
12987 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
12988
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012989fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
12990 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012991 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
12992 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012993 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
12994 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
12995 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
12996 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
12997 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020012998
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020012999fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
13000 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
13001 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
13002 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
13003
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013004fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
13005 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
13006 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
13007 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
13008 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
13009 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
13010 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
13011 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
13012 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010013013
13014 Example :
13015 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
13016 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
13017 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
13018 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
13019 frontend mail
13020 bind :25
13021 mode tcp
13022 maxconn 100
13023 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
13024 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
13025 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
13026 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013027
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013028int(<integer>) : signed integer
13029 Returns a signed integer.
13030
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020013031ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
13032 Returns an ipv4.
13033
13034ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
13035 Returns an ipv6.
13036
13037meth(<method>) : method
13038 Returns a method.
13039
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010013040nbproc : integer
13041 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
13042 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
13043 and debugging purposes.
13044
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013045nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
13046 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
13047 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
13048 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013049 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
13050 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
13051 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010013052
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010013053proc : integer
13054 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
13055 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
13056 debugging purposes.
13057
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013058queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013059 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
13060 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
13061 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013062 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
13063 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
13064 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
13065 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
13066 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
13067
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010013068rand([<range>]) : integer
13069 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
13070 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
13071 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
13072 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
13073 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
13074
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013075srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
13076 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
13077 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
13078 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
13079 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
13080 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
13081 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" fetch
13082 methods.
13083
13084srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
13085 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
13086 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
13087 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
13088 an external status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's
13089 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
13090 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
13091 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
13092
13093srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
13094 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
13095 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013096 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013097 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
13098 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
13099 rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent latent requests from
13100 overloading servers).
13101
13102 Example :
13103 # Redirect to a separate back
13104 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
13105 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
13106 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
13107
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010013108stopping : boolean
13109 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
13110 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
13111 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
13112
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020013113str(<string>) : string
13114 Returns a string.
13115
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013116table_avl([<table>]) : integer
13117 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
13118 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
13119
13120table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13121 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
13122 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
13123 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
13124
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013125var(<var-name>) : undefined
13126 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013127 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
13128 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013129 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013130 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13131 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013132 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013133 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13134 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013135 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013136 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013137
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200131387.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013139----------------------------------
13140
13141The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
13142closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
13143methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
13144sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
13145TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013146the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
13147counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
13148"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix, or it can be specified as the first integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013149argument when using the "sc_" prefix. An optional table may be specified with
13150the "sc*" form, in which case the currently tracked key will be looked up into
13151this alternate table instead of the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013152
13153be_id : integer
13154 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
13155 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
13156
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010013157be_name : string
13158 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
13159 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
13160
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013161dst : ip
13162 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
13163 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
13164 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
13165 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
13166 RFC 4291.
13167
13168dst_conn : integer
13169 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
13170 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
13171 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
13172 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
13173 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
13174 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
13175 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
13176 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013177
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020013178dst_is_local : boolean
13179 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
13180 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
13181 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
13182 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
13183 targetting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
13184 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
13185 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
13186 it only once per connection.
13187
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013188dst_port : integer
13189 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
13190 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
13191 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
13192 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
13193 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
13194 an HTTP header.
13195
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010013196fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
13197 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
13198 header.
13199
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020013200fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
13201 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
13202 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
13203 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
13204 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
13205 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
13206 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13207
13208fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
13209 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
13210 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
13211 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
13212 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
13213 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
13214 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13215
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070013216fc_unacked(<unit>) : integer
13217 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
13218 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
13219 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
13220 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13221
13222fc_sacked(<unit>) : integer
13223 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
13224 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
13225 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
13226 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13227
13228fc_retrans(<unit>) : integer
13229 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
13230 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
13231 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
13232 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13233
13234fc_fackets(<unit>) : integer
13235 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
13236 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
13237 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
13238 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13239
13240fc_lost(<unit>) : integer
13241 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
13242 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
13243 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
13244 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13245
13246fc_reordering(<unit>) : integer
13247 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
13248 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
13249 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
13250 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13251
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013252fe_id : integer
13253 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010013254 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013255 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
13256
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010013257fe_name : string
13258 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
13259 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
13260 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
13261
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013262sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013263sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
13264sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
13265sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013266 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
13267 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
13268 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
13269
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013270sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013271sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
13272sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
13273sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013274 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
13275 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
13276 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
13277
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013278sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013279sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13280sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13281sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013282 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
13283 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010013284 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
13285 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
13286 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013287
13288 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
13289 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013290 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
13291 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
13292 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013293 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
13294 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
13295
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013296sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013297sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13298sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13299sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013300 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
13301 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
13302
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013303sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013304sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
13305sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
13306sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013307 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
13308 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
13309 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
13310
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013311sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013312sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
13313sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
13314sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013315 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
13316 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
13317 See also src_conn_rate.
13318
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013319sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013320sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13321sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13322sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013323 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013324 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013325
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013326sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
13327sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
13328sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
13329sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
13330 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
13331 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
13332
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013333sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013334sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
13335sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
13336sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013337 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
13338 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
13339 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013340 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
13341 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
13342 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013343
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013344sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013345sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13346sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13347sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013348 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
13349 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
13350 See also src_http_err_cnt.
13351
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013352sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013353sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
13354sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
13355sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013356 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
13357 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
13358 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
13359 src_http_err_rate.
13360
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013361sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013362sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13363sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13364sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013365 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
13366 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
13367 src_http_req_cnt.
13368
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013369sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013370sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
13371sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
13372sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013373 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
13374 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
13375 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
13376 src_http_req_rate.
13377
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013378sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013379sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13380sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13381sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013382 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010013383 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
13384 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
13385 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
13386 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013387
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013388 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
13389 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013390 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
13391
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013392sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013393sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
13394sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
13395sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020013396 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
13397 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
13398 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013399
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013400sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013401sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
13402sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
13403sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020013404 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
13405 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
13406 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013407
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013408sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013409sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13410sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13411sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013412 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
13413 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
13414 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
13415 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013416 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013417 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
13418
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013419sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013420sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
13421sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
13422sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013423 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
13424 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
13425 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
13426 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
13427 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013428 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013429
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013430sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013431sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
13432sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
13433sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020013434 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
13435 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
13436 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
13437
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013438sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013439sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
13440sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
13441sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010013442 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
13443 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013444 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010013445 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
13446 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013447 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
13448 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
13449 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010013450
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013451so_id : integer
13452 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
13453 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
13454 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013455
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013456src : ip
13457 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
13458 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
13459 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
13460 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013461 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
13462 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
13463 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
13464 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013465
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013466 Example:
13467 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
13468 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
13469
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013470src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
13471 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
13472 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
13473 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013474 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013475
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013476src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
13477 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
13478 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013479 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013480 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013481
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013482src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13483 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
13484 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
13485 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
13486 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
13487 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
13488 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013489
13490 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
13491 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
13492 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
13493 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010013494 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013495 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
13496 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
13497
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013498src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013499 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013500 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013501 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013502 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013503
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013504src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013505 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013506 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
13507 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013508 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013509
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013510src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
13511 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
13512 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
13513 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013514 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013515
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013516src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013517 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013518 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013519 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013520 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013521
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013522src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
13523 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
13524 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
13525 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
13526 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
13527
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013528src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013529 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013530 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013531 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
13532 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013533 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
13534 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
13535 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013536
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013537src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13538 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
13539 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013540 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013541 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013542 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013543
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013544src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
13545 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
13546 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
13547 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
13548 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013549 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013550
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013551src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13552 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
13553 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
13554 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013555 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013556
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013557src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
13558 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
13559 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
13560 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013561 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013562 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013563
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013564src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13565 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
13566 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
13567 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013568 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013569 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
13570 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013571
13572 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010013573 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013574 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013575
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020013576src_is_local : boolean
13577 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
13578 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
13579 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
13580 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
13581 client comes from (eg: require auth or https for remote machines). Please
13582 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
13583 once per connection.
13584
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013585src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020013586 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
13587 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
13588 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
13589 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
13590 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013591
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013592src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020013593 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
13594 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
13595 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
13596 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
13597 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020013598
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013599src_port : integer
13600 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
13601 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
13602 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
13603 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010013604
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013605src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13606 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013607 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
13608 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
13609 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013610 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013611
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013612src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
13613 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
13614 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
13615 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
13616 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013617 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013618
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013619src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13620 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
13621 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
13622 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
13623 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
13624 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
13625 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
13626 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
13627 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020013628
13629 Example :
13630 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
13631 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
13632 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
13633 listen ssh
13634 bind :22
13635 mode tcp
13636 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013637 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013638 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020013639 server local 127.0.0.1:22
13640
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013641srv_id : integer
13642 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
13643 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
13644 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020013645
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200136467.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013647----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020013648
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013649The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
13650closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
13651when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
13652usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013653future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020013654
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001365551d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
13656 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
13657 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
13658 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
13659 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
13660 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
13661
13662 Example :
13663 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
13664 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
13665 # the request.
13666 frontend http-in
13667 bind *:8081
13668 default_backend servers
13669 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
13670 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
13671
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020013672ssl_bc : boolean
13673 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
13674 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
13675 other a server with the "ssl" option.
13676
13677ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
13678 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
13679 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13680
13681ssl_bc_cipher : string
13682 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
13683 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13684
13685ssl_bc_protocol : string
13686 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
13687 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13688
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020013689ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020013690 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020013691 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
13692 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020013693
13694ssl_bc_session_id : binary
13695 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
13696 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
13697 if session was reused or not.
13698
13699ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
13700 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
13701 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13702
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013703ssl_c_ca_err : integer
13704 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13705 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
13706 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
13707 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
13708 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020013709
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013710ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
13711 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13712 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
13713 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
13714 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013715
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010013716ssl_c_der : binary
13717 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
13718 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
13719 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
13720
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013721ssl_c_err : integer
13722 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13723 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
13724 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
13725 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
13726 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013727
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013728ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
13729 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13730 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
13731 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
13732 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
13733 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
13734 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
13735 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
13736 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013737
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013738ssl_c_key_alg : string
13739 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
13740 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13741 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013742
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013743ssl_c_notafter : string
13744 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
13745 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13746 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020013747
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013748ssl_c_notbefore : string
13749 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
13750 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13751 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010013752
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013753ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
13754 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13755 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
13756 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
13757 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
13758 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
13759 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
13760 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
13761 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010013762
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013763ssl_c_serial : binary
13764 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
13765 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
13766 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013767
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013768ssl_c_sha1 : binary
13769 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
13770 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
13771 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020013772 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
13773 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
13774
13775 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013776
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013777ssl_c_sig_alg : string
13778 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
13779 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
13780 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020013781
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013782ssl_c_used : boolean
13783 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
13784 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020013785
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013786ssl_c_verify : integer
13787 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
13788 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
13789 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
13790 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020013791
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013792ssl_c_version : integer
13793 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
13794 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020013795
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010013796ssl_f_der : binary
13797 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
13798 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
13799 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
13800
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013801ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
13802 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13803 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
13804 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
13805 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020013806 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013807 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
13808 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
13809 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020013810
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013811ssl_f_key_alg : string
13812 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
13813 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
13814 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020013815
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013816ssl_f_notafter : string
13817 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
13818 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13819 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013820
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013821ssl_f_notbefore : string
13822 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
13823 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13824 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020013825
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013826ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
13827 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13828 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
13829 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
13830 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
13831 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
13832 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
13833 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
13834 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020013835
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013836ssl_f_serial : binary
13837 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
13838 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
13839 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020013840
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020013841ssl_f_sha1 : binary
13842 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
13843 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
13844 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
13845
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013846ssl_f_sig_alg : string
13847 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
13848 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
13849 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020013850
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013851ssl_f_version : integer
13852 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
13853 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13854
13855ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013856 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
13857 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
13858 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
13859
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013860 Example :
13861 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
13862 listen http-https
13863 bind :80
13864 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
13865 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
13866
13867ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
13868 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
13869 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13870
13871ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013872 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013873 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
13874 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
13875 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
13876 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
13877 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
13878 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
13879 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
13880 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
13881
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013882ssl_fc_cipher : string
13883 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
13884 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013885
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010013886ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
13887 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
13888 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010013889 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010013890
13891ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
13892 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
13893 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010013894 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010013895
13896ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
13897 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
13898 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
13899 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
13900 avaible with OpenSSL > 1.0.2 compiled with the option enable-ssl-trace.
13901 If the function is not enabled, this sample-fetch returns the hash
13902 like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
13903
13904ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
13905 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
13906 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010013907 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010013908
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013909ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013910 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
13911 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010013912 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
13913 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
13914 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
13915 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013916
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013917ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
13918 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020013919 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
13920 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
13921 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
13922 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020013923
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020013924ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020013925 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
13926 SSL session cache or TLS tickets.
13927
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013928ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013929 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013930 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
13931 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
13932 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
13933 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
13934 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
13935 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
13936 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020013937
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013938ssl_fc_protocol : string
13939 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
13940 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020013941
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020013942ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040013943 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020013944 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
13945 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040013946
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013947ssl_fc_session_id : binary
13948 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
13949 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
13950 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
13951 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020013952
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013953ssl_fc_sni : string
13954 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
13955 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
13956 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
13957 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
13958 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
13959
13960 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
13961 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
13962 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020013963 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
13964 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013965
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013966 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013967 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
13968 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020013969
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013970ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
13971 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
13972 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020013973
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020013974
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200139757.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013976------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020013977
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013978Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
13979sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
13980only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
13981For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
13982be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
13983can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
13984sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
13985for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
13986content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013987
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013988payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
13989 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (eg:
13990 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
13991 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013992
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013993payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
13994 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
13995 (eg: "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
13996 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013997
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013998req.len : integer
13999req_len : integer (deprecated)
14000 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
14001 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
14002 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
14003 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
14004 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
14005 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
14006 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
14007 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014008
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014009req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
14010 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020014011 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
14012 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
14013 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
14014 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014015
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014016 ACL alternatives :
14017 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014018
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014019req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
14020 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
14021 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
14022 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
14023 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014024
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014025 ACL alternatives :
14026 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014027
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014028 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014029
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014030req.proto_http : boolean
14031req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
14032 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
14033 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
14034 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
14035 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
14036 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
14037 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
14038 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014039
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014040 Example:
14041 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
14042 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
14043 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014044 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014045
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014046req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
14047rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14048 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
14049 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
14050 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
14051 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
14052 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
14053 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
14054 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014055
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014056 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
14057 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
14058 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
14059 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
14060 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
14061 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014062
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014063 ACL derivatives :
14064 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014065
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014066 Example :
14067 listen tse-farm
14068 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
14069 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
14070 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
14071 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
14072 # apply RDP cookie persistence
14073 persist rdp-cookie
14074 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
14075 # This is only useful makes sense if
14076 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
14077 stick-table type string size 204800
14078 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
14079 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
14080 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014081
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014082 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
14083 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014084
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014085req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
14086rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
14087 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
14088 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
14089 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
14090 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014091
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014092 ACL derivatives :
14093 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014094
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020014095req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
14096 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
14097 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020014098 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
14099 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
14100 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
14101 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
14102 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020014103
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014104req.ssl_hello_type : integer
14105req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
14106 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
14107 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
14108 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
14109 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
14110 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
14111 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
14112 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014113
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014114req.ssl_sni : string
14115req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
14116 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
14117 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
14118 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
14119 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
14120 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
14121 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
14122 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
14123 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
14124 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
14125 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
14126 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
14127 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014128
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014129 ACL derivatives :
14130 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014131
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014132 Examples :
14133 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
14134 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
14135 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
14136 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
14137 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014138
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053014139req.ssl_st_ext : integer
14140 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
14141 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
14142 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
14143 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
14144 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
14145 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
14146 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
14147 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
14148 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
14149
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014150req.ssl_ver : integer
14151req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
14152 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
14153 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
14154 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
14155 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
14156 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
14157 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
14158 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
14159 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (eg: 3.1). This
14160 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014161
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014162 ACL derivatives :
14163 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014164
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020014165res.len : integer
14166 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
14167 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
14168 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
14169 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
14170 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
14171 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
14172 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
14173 content inspection.
14174
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014175res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
14176 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020014177 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
14178 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
14179 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
14180 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014181
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014182res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
14183 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
14184 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
14185 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
14186 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014187
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014188 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014189
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020014190res.ssl_hello_type : integer
14191rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
14192 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
14193 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
14194 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
14195 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
14196 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
14197 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
14198 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
14199
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014200wait_end : boolean
14201 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
14202 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
14203 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
14204 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
14205 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
14206 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
14207 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
14208 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014209
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014210 Examples :
14211 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
14212 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
14213 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014214
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014215 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
14216 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
14217 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
14218 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
14219 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
14220 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
14221 tcp-request content reject
14222
14223
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200142247.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014225--------------------------------------
14226
14227It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
14228This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
14229data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
14230its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
14231HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
14232content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
14233to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
14234more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
14235response are indexed.
14236
14237base : string
14238 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
14239 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
14240 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
14241 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
14242 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
14243 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
14244 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
14245 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
14246
14247 ACL derivatives :
14248 base : exact string match
14249 base_beg : prefix match
14250 base_dir : subdir match
14251 base_dom : domain match
14252 base_end : suffix match
14253 base_len : length match
14254 base_reg : regex match
14255 base_sub : substring match
14256
14257base32 : integer
14258 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
14259 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
14260 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014261 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
14262 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
14263 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014264
14265base32+src : binary
14266 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
14267 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
14268 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
14269 per-URL counters.
14270
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010014271capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
14272 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
14273 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
14274 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
14275
14276capture.req.method : string
14277 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
14278 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
14279 because it's allocated.
14280
14281capture.req.uri : string
14282 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
14283 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
14284 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
14285 allocated.
14286
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020014287capture.req.ver : string
14288 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
14289 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
14290 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
14291
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010014292capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
14293 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
14294 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
14295 The first entry is an index of 0.
14296 See also: "capture response header"
14297
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020014298capture.res.ver : string
14299 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
14300 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
14301 persistent flag.
14302
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020014303req.body : binary
14304 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
14305 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
14306 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
14307 the first chunk is analyzed.
14308
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020014309req.body_param([<name>) : string
14310 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
14311 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
14312 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
14313 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
14314 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
14315 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
14316 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
14317 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
14318 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
14319 given.
14320
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020014321req.body_len : integer
14322 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
14323 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
14324 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
14325 "option http-buffer-request".
14326
14327req.body_size : integer
14328 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
14329 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
14330 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
14331 that the request body has been buffered made available using
14332 "option http-buffer-request".
14333
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014334req.cook([<name>]) : string
14335cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14336 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
14337 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
14338 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
14339 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
14340 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
14341 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
14342 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
14343 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
14344
14345 ACL derivatives :
14346 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
14347 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
14348 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
14349 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
14350 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
14351 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
14352 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
14353 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014354
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014355req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14356cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14357 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
14358 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014359
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014360req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
14361cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14362 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
14363 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
14364 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
14365 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020014366
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014367cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14368 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
14369 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
14370 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
14371 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020014372 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014373 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
14374 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
14375 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
14376 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014377
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014378hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
14379 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
14380 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
14381 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
14382 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014383 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014384
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014385req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
14386 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
14387 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
14388 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
14389 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
14390 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
14391 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
14392 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
14393 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014394
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014395req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14396 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
14397 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
14398 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
14399 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014400
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014401req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
14402 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
14403 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
14404 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
14405 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
14406 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
14407 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
14408 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
14409 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
14410 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC2616 to know
14411 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
14412 insensitive (eg: Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014413
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014414 ACL derivatives :
14415 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
14416 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
14417 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
14418 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
14419 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
14420 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
14421 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
14422 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
14423
14424req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14425hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
14426 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
14427 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
14428 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
14429 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
14430 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
14431 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
14432 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
14433 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
14434 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
14435
14436req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
14437hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
14438 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
14439 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
14440 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
14441 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
14442 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
14443 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
14444 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
14445 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
14446
14447req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
14448hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
14449 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
14450 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
14451 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
14452 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
14453 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
14454 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
14455 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
14456
14457http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
14458 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
14459 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
14460 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
14461 basic auth is supported.
14462
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010014463http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
14464 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
14465 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
14466 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
14467 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014468 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
14469 basic auth is supported.
14470
14471 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010014472 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
14473 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
14474 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
14475 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014476
14477http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020014478 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
14479 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014480 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
14481 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020014482
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014483method : integer + string
14484 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
14485 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
14486 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
14487 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
14488 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
14489 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
14490 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014491
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014492 ACL derivatives :
14493 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014494
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014495 Example :
14496 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
14497 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
14498 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014499
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014500path : string
14501 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
14502 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
14503 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
14504 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
14505 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
14506 used to match exact file names (eg: "/login.php"), or directory parts using
14507 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014508
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014509 ACL derivatives :
14510 path : exact string match
14511 path_beg : prefix match
14512 path_dir : subdir match
14513 path_dom : domain match
14514 path_end : suffix match
14515 path_len : length match
14516 path_reg : regex match
14517 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014518
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010014519query : string
14520 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
14521 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
14522 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
14523 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014524 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010014525 which stops before the question mark.
14526
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010014527req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
14528 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
14529 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
14530 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
14531 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
14532
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014533req.ver : string
14534req_ver : string (deprecated)
14535 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
14536 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
14537 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014538
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014539 ACL derivatives :
14540 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020014541
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014542res.comp : boolean
14543 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
14544 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
14545 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014546
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014547res.comp_algo : string
14548 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
14549 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
14550 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014551
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014552res.cook([<name>]) : string
14553scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14554 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
14555 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
14556 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020014557
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014558 ACL derivatives :
14559 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020014560
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014561res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14562scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14563 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
14564 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
14565 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014566
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014567res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
14568scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14569 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
14570 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
14571 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014572
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014573res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
14574 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
14575 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
14576 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
14577 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
14578 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
14579 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
14580 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
14581 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
14582 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014583
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014584res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14585 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
14586 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
14587 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
14588 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
14589 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014590
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014591res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
14592shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
14593 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
14594 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
14595 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
14596 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
14597 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
14598 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
14599 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
14600 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014601
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014602 ACL derivatives :
14603 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
14604 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
14605 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
14606 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
14607 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
14608 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
14609 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
14610 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
14611
14612res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14613shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14614 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
14615 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
14616 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
14617 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
14618 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014619
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014620res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
14621shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
14622 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
14623 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
14624 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
14625 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
14626 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
14627 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014628
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010014629res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
14630 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
14631 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
14632 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
14633 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
14634
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014635res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
14636shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
14637 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
14638 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
14639 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
14640 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
14641 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
14642 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010014643
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014644res.ver : string
14645resp_ver : string (deprecated)
14646 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
14647 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020014648
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014649 ACL derivatives :
14650 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010014651
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014652set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14653 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
14654 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020014655 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014656 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010014657
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014658 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
14659 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010014660
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014661status : integer
14662 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
14663 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
14664 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014665
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020014666unique-id : string
14667 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
14668 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
14669 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
14670 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
14671 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
14672 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
14673
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014674url : string
14675 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
14676 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
14677 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
14678 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
14679 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
14680 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
14681 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014682
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014683 ACL derivatives :
14684 url : exact string match
14685 url_beg : prefix match
14686 url_dir : subdir match
14687 url_dom : domain match
14688 url_end : suffix match
14689 url_len : length match
14690 url_reg : regex match
14691 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014692
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014693url_ip : ip
14694 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
14695 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
14696 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
14697 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
14698 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
14699 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
14700 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014701
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014702url_port : integer
14703 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
14704 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
14705 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
14706 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014707
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020014708urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
14709url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014710 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
14711 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020014712 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
14713 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
14714 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
14715 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014716 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
14717 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020014718 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
14719 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014720
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014721 ACL derivatives :
14722 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
14723 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
14724 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
14725 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
14726 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
14727 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
14728 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
14729 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014730
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014731
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014732 Example :
14733 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
14734 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
14735 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
14736 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014737
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020014738urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>])] : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014739 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
14740 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
14741 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020014742
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020014743url32 : integer
14744 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
14745 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
14746 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
14747 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
14748 is an unsigned integer.
14749
14750url32+src : binary
14751 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
14752 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
14753 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
14754
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010014755
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200147567.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014757---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010014758
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014759Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
14760every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020014761order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010014762
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014763ACL name Equivalent to Usage
14764---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014765FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020014766HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014767HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
14768HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014769HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
14770HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
14771HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
14772HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
14773LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014774METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020014775METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014776METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
14777METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
14778METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
14779METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020014780METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014781METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020014782RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014783REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014784TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014785WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
14786---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010014787
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010014788
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200147898. Logging
14790----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014791
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014792One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
14793provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
14794very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
14795provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
14796state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014797to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014798headers.
14799
14800In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
14801about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
14802send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
14803
14804 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
14805 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
14806 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
14807 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
14808 at the termination.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060014809 - per-request control of log-level, eg:
14810 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014811
14812The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
14813allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
14814as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
14815while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
14816real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
14817delay.
14818
14819
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200148208.1. Log levels
14821---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014822
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090014823TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014824source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090014825HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
14826in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
14827track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
14828syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
14829about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014830
14831
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200148328.2. Log formats
14833----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014834
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014835HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090014836and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
14837slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
14838options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014839
14840 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
14841 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
14842 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
14843 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
14844 extents.
14845
14846 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
14847 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
14848 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
14849 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
14850 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
14851
14852 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
14853 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
14854 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
14855 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
14856 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
14857
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020014858 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
14859 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
14860 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
14861 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
14862
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010014863 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
14864
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014865Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
14866specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
14867field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
14868servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
14869always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
14870identifier.
14871
14872Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
14873 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
14874 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
14875 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
14876 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
14877
14878
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200148798.2.1. Default log format
14880-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014881
14882This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
14883as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
14884format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
14885
14886 Example :
14887 listen www
14888 mode http
14889 log global
14890 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
14891
14892 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
14893 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
14894 (www/HTTP)
14895
14896 Field Format Extract from the example above
14897 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
14898 2 'Connect from' Connect from
14899 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
14900 4 'to' to
14901 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
14902 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
14903
14904Detailed fields description :
14905 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
14906 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
14907 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
14908 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
14909 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
14910 and processed the connection.
14911 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
14912
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010014913In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
14914"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
14915connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
14916
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014917It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
14918will eventually disappear.
14919
14920
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200149218.2.2. TCP log format
14922---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014923
14924The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
14925is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
14926information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
14927counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
14928emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
14929environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
14930the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
14931sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020014932specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
14933not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
14934fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
14935marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014936
14937 Example :
14938 frontend fnt
14939 mode tcp
14940 option tcplog
14941 log global
14942 default_backend bck
14943
14944 backend bck
14945 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
14946
14947 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
14948 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
14949 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
14950
14951 Field Format Extract from the example above
14952 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
14953 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
14954 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
14955 4 frontend_name fnt
14956 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
14957 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
14958 7 bytes_read* 212
14959 8 termination_state --
14960 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
14961 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
14962
14963Detailed fields description :
14964 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010014965 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
14966 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
14967 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014968 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
14969 and the NetScaler Client IP insetion protocol is correctly used, then the
14970 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014971
14972 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010014973 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
14974 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
14975 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010014976
14977 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
14978 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
14979 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
14980 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
14981
14982 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
14983 and processed the connection.
14984
14985 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
14986 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
14987 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
14988 applications.
14989
14990 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
14991 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
14992 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
14993 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
14994 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
14995
14996 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
14997 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
14998 See "Timers" below for more details.
14999
15000 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
15001 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
15002 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
15003 "Timers" below for more details.
15004
15005 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015006 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015007 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
15008 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
15009 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
15010 details.
15011
15012 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
15013 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
15014 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
15015 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
15016 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
15017
15018 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
15019 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
15020 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
15021 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
15022 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
15023 for more details.
15024
15025 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015026 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015027 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
15028 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
15029 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015030 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015031
15032 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
15033 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
15034 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
15035 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
15036 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
15037 caused by a denial of service attack.
15038
15039 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
15040 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
15041 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
15042 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
15043 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
15044 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
15045 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
15046 denial of service attack.
15047
15048 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
15049 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
15050 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
15051 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
15052 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
15053 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
15054 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
15055 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
15056 be processed than on other servers.
15057
15058 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
15059 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
15060 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
15061 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
15062 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
15063 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
15064 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
15065 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
15066 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
15067 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
15068 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
15069 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
15070 should not be attributed to the logged server.
15071
15072 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
15073 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
15074 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
15075 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
15076 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
15077 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
15078 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
15079 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
15080
15081 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
15082 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
15083 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
15084 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
15085 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
15086 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
15087 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
15088 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
15089 occurs.
15090
15091
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200150928.2.3. HTTP log format
15093----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015094
15095The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
15096is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
15097the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
15098are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
15099emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
15100generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
15101"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
15102which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020015103frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
15104is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015105
15106Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
15107slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
15108with a star ('*') after the field name below.
15109
15110 Example :
15111 frontend http-in
15112 mode http
15113 option httplog
15114 log global
15115 default_backend bck
15116
15117 backend static
15118 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
15119
15120 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
15121 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
15122 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015123 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015124
15125 Field Format Extract from the example above
15126 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
15127 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015128 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015129 4 frontend_name http-in
15130 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015131 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015132 7 status_code 200
15133 8 bytes_read* 2750
15134 9 captured_request_cookie -
15135 10 captured_response_cookie -
15136 11 termination_state ----
15137 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
15138 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
15139 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
15140 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
15141 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015142
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015143Detailed fields description :
15144 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015145 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
15146 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
15147 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015148 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
15149 and the NetScaler Client IP insetion protocol is correctly used, then the
15150 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015151
15152 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015153 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
15154 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
15155 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015156
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015157 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
15158 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015159
15160 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
15161 and processed the connection.
15162
15163 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
15164 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
15165 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
15166
15167 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
15168 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
15169 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
15170 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
15171 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
15172 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
15173
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015174 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
15175 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
15176 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
15177 request could be received or the a bad request was received. It should
15178 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
15179 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
15180 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See "Timers" below for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015181
15182 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
15183 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
15184 See "Timers" below for more details.
15185
15186 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
15187 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
15188 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
15189 below for more details.
15190
15191 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
15192 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
15193 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
15194 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
15195 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
15196 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
15197 for more details.
15198
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015199 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
15200 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
15201 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
15202 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
15203 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
15204 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
15205 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
15206 See "Timers" below for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015207
15208 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
15209 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
15210 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
15211
15212 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
15213 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
15214 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
15215 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
15216 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
15217 overflowing.
15218
15219 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
15220 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
15221 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
15222 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
15223 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
15224 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
15225 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
15226 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
15227
15228 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
15229 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
15230 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
15231 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
15232 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
15233 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
15234 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
15235 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
15236
15237 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
15238 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
15239 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
15240 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
15241 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
15242 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
15243 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
15244
15245 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015246 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015247 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
15248 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
15249 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015250 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015251 system.
15252
15253 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
15254 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
15255 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
15256 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
15257 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
15258 caused by a denial of service attack.
15259
15260 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
15261 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
15262 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
15263 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
15264 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
15265 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
15266 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
15267 denial of service attack.
15268
15269 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
15270 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
15271 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
15272 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
15273 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
15274 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
15275 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
15276 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
15277 processed than on other servers.
15278
15279 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
15280 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
15281 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
15282 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
15283 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
15284 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
15285 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
15286 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
15287 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
15288 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
15289 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
15290 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
15291 should not be attributed to the logged server.
15292
15293 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
15294 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
15295 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
15296 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
15297 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
15298 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
15299 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
15300 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
15301
15302 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
15303 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
15304 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
15305 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
15306 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
15307 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
15308 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
15309 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
15310 occurs.
15311
15312 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
15313 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
15314 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
15315 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
15316 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
15317 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
15318 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
15319 cookies" below for more details.
15320
15321 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
15322 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
15323 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
15324 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
15325 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
15326 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
15327 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
15328 and cookies" below for more details.
15329
15330 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
15331 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
15332 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
15333 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
15334 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
15335 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
15336 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
15337 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
15338
15339
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200153408.2.4. Custom log format
15341------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015342
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015343The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015344mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015345
15346HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
15347Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
15348separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
15349prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
15350
15351Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
15352variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010015353("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015354
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010015355If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020015356as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010015357less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
15358the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
15359
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015360Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015361In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010015362in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015363
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010015364Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
15365'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
15366https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
15367such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
15368
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015369Flags are :
15370 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015371 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010015372 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
15373 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015374
15375 Example:
15376
15377 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
15378 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
15379
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010015380 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
15381
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015382At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
15383
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015384 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
15385 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015386
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015387the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015388
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015389 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
15390 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
15391 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015392
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015393and the default TCP format is defined this way :
15394
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015395 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
15396 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015397
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015398Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
15399
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015400 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015401 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015402 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
15403 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
15404 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015405 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
15406 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
15407 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020015408 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000015409 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
15410 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000015411 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000015412 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
15413 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010015414 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020015415 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020015416 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015417 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015418 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020015419 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080015420 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015421 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
15422 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
15423 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
15424 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
15425 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020015426 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015427 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
15428 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015429 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015430 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
15431 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015432 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
15433 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
15434 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015435 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015436 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
15437 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015438 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015439 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
15440 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
15441 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020015442 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020015443 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020015444 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
15445 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
15446 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
15447 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020015448 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020015449 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015450 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015451 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010015452 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015453 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015454 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
15455 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
15456 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015457 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015458 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
15459 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015460 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015461 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
15462 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
15463 | H | %trl | locla_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015464 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015465 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015466 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015467
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015468 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015469
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010015470
154718.2.5. Error log format
15472-----------------------
15473
15474When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
15475protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
15476By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
15477"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
15478will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (eg: probes) are not
15479logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
15480
15481The format looks like this :
15482
15483 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
15484 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
15485 Connection error during SSL handshake
15486
15487 Field Format Extract from the example above
15488 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
15489 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
15490 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
15491 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
15492 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
15493
15494These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
15495failures.
15496
15497
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200154988.3. Advanced logging options
15499-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015500
15501Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
15502just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
15503options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
15504for more information about their usage.
15505
15506
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200155078.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
15508------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015509
15510It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
15511haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
15512commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
15513monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
15514ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
15515
15516 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
15517 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
15518 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
15519 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
15520
15521 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
15522 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
15523 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015524 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015525 such as other load-balancers.
15526
15527 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
15528 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
15529 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
15530
15531
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200155328.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
15533----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015534
15535The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
15536what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
15537or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
15538"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
15539just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
15540log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
15541after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
15542is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
15543with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
15544with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
15545
15546
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200155478.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
15548------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020015549
15550Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
15551for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
15552"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
15553retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
15554raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
15555a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
15556file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
15557you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
15558"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
15559
15560
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200155618.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
15562--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020015563
15564Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
15565multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
15566them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
15567"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
15568logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
15569error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
15570and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
15571too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
15572useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
15573alternative.
15574
15575
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200155768.4. Timing events
15577------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015578
15579Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
15580reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
15581the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
15582frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015583mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
15584addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
15585
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010015586Timings events in HTTP mode:
15587
15588 first request 2nd request
15589 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
15590 t tr t tr ...
15591 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
15592 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
15593 :<---- Tq ---->: :
15594 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
15595 :<--------- Ta --------->:
15596
15597Timings events in TCP mode:
15598
15599 TCP session
15600 |<----------------->|
15601 t t
15602 ---|----|----|----|----|---
15603 | Th Tw Tc Td |
15604 |<------ Tt ------->|
15605
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015606 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
15607 protocols. Currently, these protocoles are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
15608 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
15609 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
15610 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
15611 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (eg: MTU issues), or that an
15612 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015613
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015614 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
15615 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
15616 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
15617 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. Some
15618 browsers pre-establish connections to a server in order to reduce the
15619 latency of a future request, and keep them pending until they need it. This
15620 delay will be reported as the idle time. A value of -1 indicates that
15621 nothing was received on the connection.
15622
15623 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
15624 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
15625 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
15626 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
15627 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
15628 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
15629 request typed by hand during a test.
15630
15631 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
15632 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
15633 exactly equalt to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
15634 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
15635 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
15636 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
15637 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015638
15639 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
15640 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
15641 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
15642 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
15643 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
15644
15645 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
15646 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
15647 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
15648 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
15649 connection never established.
15650
15651 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
15652 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
15653 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
15654 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
15655 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
15656 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
15657 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
15658 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
15659 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
15660 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
15661 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
15662
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015663 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
15664 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
15665 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
15666 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
15667 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
15668 by subtracting other timers when valid :
15669
15670 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
15671
15672 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
15673 "Ta" can never be negative.
15674
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015675 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
15676 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015677 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
15678 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015679 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015680
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015681 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015682
15683 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015684 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
15685 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015686
15687These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
15688protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
15689that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015690due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
15691"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
15692that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015693
15694Most common cases :
15695
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015696 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
15697 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
15698 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
15699 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
15700 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
15701 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
15702 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
15703 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
15704 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
15705 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
15706 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020015707 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015708
15709 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
15710 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
15711 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
15712 of ms on remote networks.
15713
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015714 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
15715 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
15716 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015717
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015718 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
15719 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
15720 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
15721 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
15722 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
15723 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
15724 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
15725 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
15726 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015727
15728Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
15729
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015730 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015731 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015732 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015733
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015734 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015735 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
15736 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
15737
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015738 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015739 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
15740 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
15741 flags.
15742
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015743 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
15744 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015745 Check the session termination flags, then check the
15746 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
15747 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
15748 the client connection was maintained open.
15749
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015750 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015751 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015752 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015753 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
15754
15755
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200157568.5. Session state at disconnection
15757-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015758
15759TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
15760"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
157612-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
15762each of which has a special meaning :
15763
15764 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
15765 session to terminate :
15766
15767 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
15768
15769 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
15770 server explicitly refused it.
15771
15772 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
15773 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
15774 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
15775 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020015776 (eg: cacheable cookie).
15777
15778 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
15779 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015780
15781 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
15782 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
15783 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
15784 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
15785 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
15786
15787 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
15788 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
15789 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
15790 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
15791 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
15792
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090015793 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
15794 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
15795
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070015796 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
15797 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
15798 backup connections when going up.
15799
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020015800 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
15801
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015802 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
15803 send or receive data.
15804
15805 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
15806 send or receive data.
15807
15808 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
15809 with nothing left in the buffers.
15810
15811 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
15812
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010015813 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015814 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
15815
15816 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
15817 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
15818 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
15819 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
15820 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
15821
15822 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
15823 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
15824
15825 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
15826 server (HTTP only).
15827
15828 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
15829
15830 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
15831 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
15832 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
15833
15834 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
15835 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
15836 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
15837
15838 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
15839
15840 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
15841 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
15842
15843 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
15844 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
15845 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
15846
15847 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
15848 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020015849 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
15850 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015851
15852 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
15853 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
15854 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
15855 another server.
15856
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015857 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015858 server.
15859
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015860 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
15861 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
15862 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
15863 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
15864
15865 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
15866 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
15867 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
15868 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
15869
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020015870 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
15871 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
15872 "use-server" rule).
15873
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015874 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
15875
15876 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
15877 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
15878
15879 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
15880
15881 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
15882 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
15883 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
15884
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015885 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
15886 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015887 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015888 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
15889 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
15890
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015891 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
15892
15893 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
15894 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
15895
15896 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
15897
15898 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
15899
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020015900The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
15901was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015902helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
15903starvation, attacks, etc...
15904
15905The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
15906alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
15907easier finding and understanding.
15908
15909 Flags Reason
15910
15911 -- Normal termination.
15912
15913 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
15914 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
15915 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
15916 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
15917
15918 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
15919 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
15920 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
15921 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
15922 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
15923 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015924
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015925 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
15926 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020015927 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015928
15929 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
15930 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
15931 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
15932
15933 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
15934 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
15935 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
15936 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
15937 the server takes too long to respond.
15938
15939 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
15940 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
15941 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
15942 long a time to respond.
15943
15944 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
15945 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
15946 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
15947 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020015948 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
15949 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015950
15951 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
15952 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
15953 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
15954 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
15955 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020015956 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020015957 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
15958 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
15959 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
15960 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
15961 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
15962 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
15963 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
15964 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
15965 around the undesirable effects of this behaviour by adding "option
15966 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
15967 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
15968 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015969
15970 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
15971 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015972 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
15973 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
15974 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
15975 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015976
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020015977 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
15978 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
15979
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010015980 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015981 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
15982 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
15983 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
15984 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
15985 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
15986
15987 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
15988 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
15989 503 or 504 here.
15990
15991 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
15992 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
15993 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
15994 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
15995 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
15996
15997 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
15998 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010015999 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016000 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
16001 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
16002
16003 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
16004 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
16005 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
16006 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
16007 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
16008 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
16009 between haproxy and the server.
16010
16011 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
16012 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
16013 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
16014 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
16015 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
16016 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
16017 solution is to fix the application.
16018
16019 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
16020 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
16021 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
16022 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
16023 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
16024 external attacks.
16025
16026 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
16027 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020016028 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016029 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
16030 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
16031
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010016032 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
16033 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
16034 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020016035 the client. Haproxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
16036 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010016037
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016038 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
16039 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
16040 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
16041 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010016042 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
16043 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
16044 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
16045 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
16046 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016047
16048 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
16049 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
16050 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
16051 returned an HTTP 403 error.
16052
16053 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
16054 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
16055 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
16056 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
16057
16058 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
16059 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
16060 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
16061 only be solved by proper system tuning.
16062
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016063The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
16064persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
16065important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
16066re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
16067
16068 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
16069
16070 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
16071 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
16072 set on a GET request.
16073
16074 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
16075 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016076 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016077 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
16078
16079 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
16080 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
16081 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
16082
16083 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
16084 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
16085 already got a cookie.
16086
16087 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
16088 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
16089 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
16090 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
16091 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
16092
16093 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
16094 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
16095 new cookie was inserted in the response.
16096
16097 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
16098 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
16099 new cookie was inserted in the response.
16100
16101 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
16102 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
16103
16104 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
16105 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
16106 then advertised in the response.
16107
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016108
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200161098.6. Non-printable characters
16110-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016111
16112In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
16113consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
16114converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
16115prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
16116being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
16117escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
16118is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
16119'}' when logging headers.
16120
16121Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
16122issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
16123containing spaces is "User-Agent".
16124
16125Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
16126the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
16127performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
16128
16129
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200161308.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
16131---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016132
16133Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
16134achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016135section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016136cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
16137the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
16138the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016139locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016140not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
16141user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
16142a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
16143wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
16144
16145 Examples :
16146 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
16147 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
16148
16149 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
16150 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
16151
16152
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200161538.8. Capturing HTTP headers
16154---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016155
16156Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
16157proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
16158the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
16159server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
16160
16161Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
16162response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016163section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016164
16165It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016166time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
16167appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016168are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
16169and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
16170follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
16171request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
16172in the logs.
16173
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020016174As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
16175frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
16176an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
16177
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016178 Example :
16179 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
16180 listen proxy-out
16181 mode http
16182 option httplog
16183 option logasap
16184 log global
16185 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
16186
16187 # log the name of the virtual server
16188 capture request header Host len 20
16189
16190 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
16191 capture request header Content-Length len 10
16192
16193 # log the beginning of the referrer
16194 capture request header Referer len 20
16195
16196 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
16197 capture response header Server len 20
16198
16199 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
16200 capture response header Content-Length len 10
16201
16202 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
16203 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
16204
16205 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
16206 capture response header Via len 20
16207
16208 # log the URL location during a redirection
16209 capture response header Location len 20
16210
16211 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
16212 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
16213 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
16214 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
16215 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
16216
16217 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
16218 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
16219 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
16220 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016221 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016222
16223 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
16224 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
16225 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
16226 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
16227 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016228 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016229
16230
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200162318.9. Examples of logs
16232---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016233
16234These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
16235them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
16236reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
16237
16238 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
16239 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
16240 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
16241
16242 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
16243 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
16244
16245 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
16246 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
16247 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
16248
16249 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
16250 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
16251
16252 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
16253 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
16254 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
16255
16256 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016257 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016258 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
16259 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
16260
16261 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
16262 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
16263 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
16264
16265 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
16266 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020016267 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016268 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
16269 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
16270 to return the 502 and not the server.
16271
16272 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016273 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016274
16275 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
16276 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
16277 Nothing was sent to any server.
16278
16279 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
16280 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
16281
16282 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
16283 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
16284 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
16285 send a 408 return code to the client.
16286
16287 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
16288 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
16289
16290 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
16291 5 seconds ("c----").
16292
16293 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
16294 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016295 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016296
16297 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016298 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016299 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
16300 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
16301 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
16302 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
16303 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010016304
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020016305
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200163069. Supported filters
16307--------------------
16308
16309Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
16310accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
16311unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
16312
16313See also : "filter"
16314
163159.1. Trace
16316----------
16317
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010016318filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020016319
16320 Arguments:
16321 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
16322 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
16323
16324 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
16325 the client and the server. By default, this filter
16326 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
16327 only parses a random amount of the available data.
16328
16329 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwading of parsed data. By
16330 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
16331 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
16332 amount of the parsed data.
16333
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010016334 <hexump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
16335
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020016336This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
16337callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
16338information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
16339filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
16340
16341Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
16342tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
16343a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
16344
16345
163469.2. HTTP compression
16347---------------------
16348
16349filter compression
16350
16351The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
16352keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
16353when no other filter is used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly
16354use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when two or more filters are
16355used for the same listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the
16356filters evaluation order.
16357
16358See also : "compression"
16359
16360
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200163619.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
16362--------------------------------------------
16363
16364filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
16365
16366 Arguments :
16367
16368 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
16369 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
16370 parsed.
16371
16372 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
16373 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
16374 part must be placed in its own scope.
16375
16376The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
16377external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
16378streams in tierce applications. These external components and information
16379exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
16380also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
16381
16382SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
16383the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
16384
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016385For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020016386"doc/SPOE.txt".
16387
16388Important note:
16389 The SPOE filter is highly experimental for now and was not heavily
16390 tested. It is really not production ready. So use it carefully.
16391
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016392/*
16393 * Local variables:
16394 * fill-column: 79
16395 * End:
16396 */